OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/openrisc/openrisc/trunk

Subversion Repositories openrisc

[/] [openrisc/] [trunk/] [gnu-old/] [gcc-4.2.2/] [gcc/] [function.c] - Diff between revs 154 and 816

Go to most recent revision | Only display areas with differences | Details | Blame | View Log

Rev 154 Rev 816
/* Expands front end tree to back end RTL for GCC.
/* Expands front end tree to back end RTL for GCC.
   Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1989, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997,
   Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1989, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997,
   1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007
   1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007
   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 
 
This file is part of GCC.
This file is part of GCC.
 
 
GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
version.
version.
 
 
GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU General Public License
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU General Public License
for more details.
for more details.
 
 
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with GCC; see the file COPYING3.  If not see
along with GCC; see the file COPYING3.  If not see
<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.  */
<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.  */
 
 
/* This file handles the generation of rtl code from tree structure
/* This file handles the generation of rtl code from tree structure
   at the level of the function as a whole.
   at the level of the function as a whole.
   It creates the rtl expressions for parameters and auto variables
   It creates the rtl expressions for parameters and auto variables
   and has full responsibility for allocating stack slots.
   and has full responsibility for allocating stack slots.
 
 
   `expand_function_start' is called at the beginning of a function,
   `expand_function_start' is called at the beginning of a function,
   before the function body is parsed, and `expand_function_end' is
   before the function body is parsed, and `expand_function_end' is
   called after parsing the body.
   called after parsing the body.
 
 
   Call `assign_stack_local' to allocate a stack slot for a local variable.
   Call `assign_stack_local' to allocate a stack slot for a local variable.
   This is usually done during the RTL generation for the function body,
   This is usually done during the RTL generation for the function body,
   but it can also be done in the reload pass when a pseudo-register does
   but it can also be done in the reload pass when a pseudo-register does
   not get a hard register.  */
   not get a hard register.  */
 
 
#include "config.h"
#include "config.h"
#include "system.h"
#include "system.h"
#include "coretypes.h"
#include "coretypes.h"
#include "tm.h"
#include "tm.h"
#include "rtl.h"
#include "rtl.h"
#include "tree.h"
#include "tree.h"
#include "flags.h"
#include "flags.h"
#include "except.h"
#include "except.h"
#include "function.h"
#include "function.h"
#include "expr.h"
#include "expr.h"
#include "optabs.h"
#include "optabs.h"
#include "libfuncs.h"
#include "libfuncs.h"
#include "regs.h"
#include "regs.h"
#include "hard-reg-set.h"
#include "hard-reg-set.h"
#include "insn-config.h"
#include "insn-config.h"
#include "recog.h"
#include "recog.h"
#include "output.h"
#include "output.h"
#include "basic-block.h"
#include "basic-block.h"
#include "toplev.h"
#include "toplev.h"
#include "hashtab.h"
#include "hashtab.h"
#include "ggc.h"
#include "ggc.h"
#include "tm_p.h"
#include "tm_p.h"
#include "integrate.h"
#include "integrate.h"
#include "langhooks.h"
#include "langhooks.h"
#include "target.h"
#include "target.h"
#include "cfglayout.h"
#include "cfglayout.h"
#include "tree-gimple.h"
#include "tree-gimple.h"
#include "tree-pass.h"
#include "tree-pass.h"
#include "predict.h"
#include "predict.h"
#include "vecprim.h"
#include "vecprim.h"
 
 
#ifndef LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
#ifndef LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
#define LOCAL_ALIGNMENT(TYPE, ALIGNMENT) ALIGNMENT
#define LOCAL_ALIGNMENT(TYPE, ALIGNMENT) ALIGNMENT
#endif
#endif
 
 
#ifndef STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
#ifndef STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
#define STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED 1
#define STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED 1
#endif
#endif
 
 
#define STACK_BYTES (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)
#define STACK_BYTES (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)
 
 
/* Some systems use __main in a way incompatible with its use in gcc, in these
/* Some systems use __main in a way incompatible with its use in gcc, in these
   cases use the macros NAME__MAIN to give a quoted symbol and SYMBOL__MAIN to
   cases use the macros NAME__MAIN to give a quoted symbol and SYMBOL__MAIN to
   give the same symbol without quotes for an alternative entry point.  You
   give the same symbol without quotes for an alternative entry point.  You
   must define both, or neither.  */
   must define both, or neither.  */
#ifndef NAME__MAIN
#ifndef NAME__MAIN
#define NAME__MAIN "__main"
#define NAME__MAIN "__main"
#endif
#endif
 
 
/* Round a value to the lowest integer less than it that is a multiple of
/* Round a value to the lowest integer less than it that is a multiple of
   the required alignment.  Avoid using division in case the value is
   the required alignment.  Avoid using division in case the value is
   negative.  Assume the alignment is a power of two.  */
   negative.  Assume the alignment is a power of two.  */
#define FLOOR_ROUND(VALUE,ALIGN) ((VALUE) & ~((ALIGN) - 1))
#define FLOOR_ROUND(VALUE,ALIGN) ((VALUE) & ~((ALIGN) - 1))
 
 
/* Similar, but round to the next highest integer that meets the
/* Similar, but round to the next highest integer that meets the
   alignment.  */
   alignment.  */
#define CEIL_ROUND(VALUE,ALIGN) (((VALUE) + (ALIGN) - 1) & ~((ALIGN)- 1))
#define CEIL_ROUND(VALUE,ALIGN) (((VALUE) + (ALIGN) - 1) & ~((ALIGN)- 1))
 
 
/* Nonzero if function being compiled doesn't contain any calls
/* Nonzero if function being compiled doesn't contain any calls
   (ignoring the prologue and epilogue).  This is set prior to
   (ignoring the prologue and epilogue).  This is set prior to
   local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
   local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
   compiler passes.  */
   compiler passes.  */
int current_function_is_leaf;
int current_function_is_leaf;
 
 
/* Nonzero if function being compiled doesn't modify the stack pointer
/* Nonzero if function being compiled doesn't modify the stack pointer
   (ignoring the prologue and epilogue).  This is only valid after
   (ignoring the prologue and epilogue).  This is only valid after
   life_analysis has run.  */
   life_analysis has run.  */
int current_function_sp_is_unchanging;
int current_function_sp_is_unchanging;
 
 
/* Nonzero if the function being compiled is a leaf function which only
/* Nonzero if the function being compiled is a leaf function which only
   uses leaf registers.  This is valid after reload (specifically after
   uses leaf registers.  This is valid after reload (specifically after
   sched2) and is useful only if the port defines LEAF_REGISTERS.  */
   sched2) and is useful only if the port defines LEAF_REGISTERS.  */
int current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs;
int current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs;
 
 
/* Nonzero once virtual register instantiation has been done.
/* Nonzero once virtual register instantiation has been done.
   assign_stack_local uses frame_pointer_rtx when this is nonzero.
   assign_stack_local uses frame_pointer_rtx when this is nonzero.
   calls.c:emit_library_call_value_1 uses it to set up
   calls.c:emit_library_call_value_1 uses it to set up
   post-instantiation libcalls.  */
   post-instantiation libcalls.  */
int virtuals_instantiated;
int virtuals_instantiated;
 
 
/* Assign unique numbers to labels generated for profiling, debugging, etc.  */
/* Assign unique numbers to labels generated for profiling, debugging, etc.  */
static GTY(()) int funcdef_no;
static GTY(()) int funcdef_no;
 
 
/* These variables hold pointers to functions to create and destroy
/* These variables hold pointers to functions to create and destroy
   target specific, per-function data structures.  */
   target specific, per-function data structures.  */
struct machine_function * (*init_machine_status) (void);
struct machine_function * (*init_machine_status) (void);
 
 
/* The currently compiled function.  */
/* The currently compiled function.  */
struct function *cfun = 0;
struct function *cfun = 0;
 
 
/* These arrays record the INSN_UIDs of the prologue and epilogue insns.  */
/* These arrays record the INSN_UIDs of the prologue and epilogue insns.  */
static VEC(int,heap) *prologue;
static VEC(int,heap) *prologue;
static VEC(int,heap) *epilogue;
static VEC(int,heap) *epilogue;
 
 
/* Array of INSN_UIDs to hold the INSN_UIDs for each sibcall epilogue
/* Array of INSN_UIDs to hold the INSN_UIDs for each sibcall epilogue
   in this function.  */
   in this function.  */
static VEC(int,heap) *sibcall_epilogue;
static VEC(int,heap) *sibcall_epilogue;


/* In order to evaluate some expressions, such as function calls returning
/* In order to evaluate some expressions, such as function calls returning
   structures in memory, we need to temporarily allocate stack locations.
   structures in memory, we need to temporarily allocate stack locations.
   We record each allocated temporary in the following structure.
   We record each allocated temporary in the following structure.
 
 
   Associated with each temporary slot is a nesting level.  When we pop up
   Associated with each temporary slot is a nesting level.  When we pop up
   one level, all temporaries associated with the previous level are freed.
   one level, all temporaries associated with the previous level are freed.
   Normally, all temporaries are freed after the execution of the statement
   Normally, all temporaries are freed after the execution of the statement
   in which they were created.  However, if we are inside a ({...}) grouping,
   in which they were created.  However, if we are inside a ({...}) grouping,
   the result may be in a temporary and hence must be preserved.  If the
   the result may be in a temporary and hence must be preserved.  If the
   result could be in a temporary, we preserve it if we can determine which
   result could be in a temporary, we preserve it if we can determine which
   one it is in.  If we cannot determine which temporary may contain the
   one it is in.  If we cannot determine which temporary may contain the
   result, all temporaries are preserved.  A temporary is preserved by
   result, all temporaries are preserved.  A temporary is preserved by
   pretending it was allocated at the previous nesting level.
   pretending it was allocated at the previous nesting level.
 
 
   Automatic variables are also assigned temporary slots, at the nesting
   Automatic variables are also assigned temporary slots, at the nesting
   level where they are defined.  They are marked a "kept" so that
   level where they are defined.  They are marked a "kept" so that
   free_temp_slots will not free them.  */
   free_temp_slots will not free them.  */
 
 
struct temp_slot GTY(())
struct temp_slot GTY(())
{
{
  /* Points to next temporary slot.  */
  /* Points to next temporary slot.  */
  struct temp_slot *next;
  struct temp_slot *next;
  /* Points to previous temporary slot.  */
  /* Points to previous temporary slot.  */
  struct temp_slot *prev;
  struct temp_slot *prev;
 
 
  /* The rtx to used to reference the slot.  */
  /* The rtx to used to reference the slot.  */
  rtx slot;
  rtx slot;
  /* The rtx used to represent the address if not the address of the
  /* The rtx used to represent the address if not the address of the
     slot above.  May be an EXPR_LIST if multiple addresses exist.  */
     slot above.  May be an EXPR_LIST if multiple addresses exist.  */
  rtx address;
  rtx address;
  /* The alignment (in bits) of the slot.  */
  /* The alignment (in bits) of the slot.  */
  unsigned int align;
  unsigned int align;
  /* The size, in units, of the slot.  */
  /* The size, in units, of the slot.  */
  HOST_WIDE_INT size;
  HOST_WIDE_INT size;
  /* The type of the object in the slot, or zero if it doesn't correspond
  /* The type of the object in the slot, or zero if it doesn't correspond
     to a type.  We use this to determine whether a slot can be reused.
     to a type.  We use this to determine whether a slot can be reused.
     It can be reused if objects of the type of the new slot will always
     It can be reused if objects of the type of the new slot will always
     conflict with objects of the type of the old slot.  */
     conflict with objects of the type of the old slot.  */
  tree type;
  tree type;
  /* Nonzero if this temporary is currently in use.  */
  /* Nonzero if this temporary is currently in use.  */
  char in_use;
  char in_use;
  /* Nonzero if this temporary has its address taken.  */
  /* Nonzero if this temporary has its address taken.  */
  char addr_taken;
  char addr_taken;
  /* Nesting level at which this slot is being used.  */
  /* Nesting level at which this slot is being used.  */
  int level;
  int level;
  /* Nonzero if this should survive a call to free_temp_slots.  */
  /* Nonzero if this should survive a call to free_temp_slots.  */
  int keep;
  int keep;
  /* The offset of the slot from the frame_pointer, including extra space
  /* The offset of the slot from the frame_pointer, including extra space
     for alignment.  This info is for combine_temp_slots.  */
     for alignment.  This info is for combine_temp_slots.  */
  HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
  HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
  /* The size of the slot, including extra space for alignment.  This
  /* The size of the slot, including extra space for alignment.  This
     info is for combine_temp_slots.  */
     info is for combine_temp_slots.  */
  HOST_WIDE_INT full_size;
  HOST_WIDE_INT full_size;
};
};


/* Forward declarations.  */
/* Forward declarations.  */
 
 
static rtx assign_stack_local_1 (enum machine_mode, HOST_WIDE_INT, int,
static rtx assign_stack_local_1 (enum machine_mode, HOST_WIDE_INT, int,
                                 struct function *);
                                 struct function *);
static struct temp_slot *find_temp_slot_from_address (rtx);
static struct temp_slot *find_temp_slot_from_address (rtx);
static void pad_to_arg_alignment (struct args_size *, int, struct args_size *);
static void pad_to_arg_alignment (struct args_size *, int, struct args_size *);
static void pad_below (struct args_size *, enum machine_mode, tree);
static void pad_below (struct args_size *, enum machine_mode, tree);
static void reorder_blocks_1 (rtx, tree, VEC(tree,heap) **);
static void reorder_blocks_1 (rtx, tree, VEC(tree,heap) **);
static int all_blocks (tree, tree *);
static int all_blocks (tree, tree *);
static tree *get_block_vector (tree, int *);
static tree *get_block_vector (tree, int *);
extern tree debug_find_var_in_block_tree (tree, tree);
extern tree debug_find_var_in_block_tree (tree, tree);
/* We always define `record_insns' even if it's not used so that we
/* We always define `record_insns' even if it's not used so that we
   can always export `prologue_epilogue_contains'.  */
   can always export `prologue_epilogue_contains'.  */
static void record_insns (rtx, VEC(int,heap) **) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
static void record_insns (rtx, VEC(int,heap) **) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
static int contains (rtx, VEC(int,heap) **);
static int contains (rtx, VEC(int,heap) **);
#ifdef HAVE_return
#ifdef HAVE_return
static void emit_return_into_block (basic_block, rtx);
static void emit_return_into_block (basic_block, rtx);
#endif
#endif
#if defined(HAVE_epilogue) && defined(INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX)
#if defined(HAVE_epilogue) && defined(INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX)
static rtx keep_stack_depressed (rtx);
static rtx keep_stack_depressed (rtx);
#endif
#endif
static void prepare_function_start (tree);
static void prepare_function_start (tree);
static void do_clobber_return_reg (rtx, void *);
static void do_clobber_return_reg (rtx, void *);
static void do_use_return_reg (rtx, void *);
static void do_use_return_reg (rtx, void *);
static void set_insn_locators (rtx, int) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
static void set_insn_locators (rtx, int) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;


/* Pointer to chain of `struct function' for containing functions.  */
/* Pointer to chain of `struct function' for containing functions.  */
struct function *outer_function_chain;
struct function *outer_function_chain;
 
 
/* Given a function decl for a containing function,
/* Given a function decl for a containing function,
   return the `struct function' for it.  */
   return the `struct function' for it.  */
 
 
struct function *
struct function *
find_function_data (tree decl)
find_function_data (tree decl)
{
{
  struct function *p;
  struct function *p;
 
 
  for (p = outer_function_chain; p; p = p->outer)
  for (p = outer_function_chain; p; p = p->outer)
    if (p->decl == decl)
    if (p->decl == decl)
      return p;
      return p;
 
 
  gcc_unreachable ();
  gcc_unreachable ();
}
}
 
 
/* Save the current context for compilation of a nested function.
/* Save the current context for compilation of a nested function.
   This is called from language-specific code.  The caller should use
   This is called from language-specific code.  The caller should use
   the enter_nested langhook to save any language-specific state,
   the enter_nested langhook to save any language-specific state,
   since this function knows only about language-independent
   since this function knows only about language-independent
   variables.  */
   variables.  */
 
 
void
void
push_function_context_to (tree context ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
push_function_context_to (tree context ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
{
{
  struct function *p;
  struct function *p;
 
 
  if (cfun == 0)
  if (cfun == 0)
    init_dummy_function_start ();
    init_dummy_function_start ();
  p = cfun;
  p = cfun;
 
 
  p->outer = outer_function_chain;
  p->outer = outer_function_chain;
  outer_function_chain = p;
  outer_function_chain = p;
 
 
  lang_hooks.function.enter_nested (p);
  lang_hooks.function.enter_nested (p);
 
 
  cfun = 0;
  cfun = 0;
}
}
 
 
void
void
push_function_context (void)
push_function_context (void)
{
{
  push_function_context_to (current_function_decl);
  push_function_context_to (current_function_decl);
}
}
 
 
/* Restore the last saved context, at the end of a nested function.
/* Restore the last saved context, at the end of a nested function.
   This function is called from language-specific code.  */
   This function is called from language-specific code.  */
 
 
void
void
pop_function_context_from (tree context ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
pop_function_context_from (tree context ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
{
{
  struct function *p = outer_function_chain;
  struct function *p = outer_function_chain;
 
 
  cfun = p;
  cfun = p;
  outer_function_chain = p->outer;
  outer_function_chain = p->outer;
 
 
  current_function_decl = p->decl;
  current_function_decl = p->decl;
 
 
  lang_hooks.function.leave_nested (p);
  lang_hooks.function.leave_nested (p);
 
 
  /* Reset variables that have known state during rtx generation.  */
  /* Reset variables that have known state during rtx generation.  */
  virtuals_instantiated = 0;
  virtuals_instantiated = 0;
  generating_concat_p = 1;
  generating_concat_p = 1;
}
}
 
 
void
void
pop_function_context (void)
pop_function_context (void)
{
{
  pop_function_context_from (current_function_decl);
  pop_function_context_from (current_function_decl);
}
}
 
 
/* Clear out all parts of the state in F that can safely be discarded
/* Clear out all parts of the state in F that can safely be discarded
   after the function has been parsed, but not compiled, to let
   after the function has been parsed, but not compiled, to let
   garbage collection reclaim the memory.  */
   garbage collection reclaim the memory.  */
 
 
void
void
free_after_parsing (struct function *f)
free_after_parsing (struct function *f)
{
{
  /* f->expr->forced_labels is used by code generation.  */
  /* f->expr->forced_labels is used by code generation.  */
  /* f->emit->regno_reg_rtx is used by code generation.  */
  /* f->emit->regno_reg_rtx is used by code generation.  */
  /* f->varasm is used by code generation.  */
  /* f->varasm is used by code generation.  */
  /* f->eh->eh_return_stub_label is used by code generation.  */
  /* f->eh->eh_return_stub_label is used by code generation.  */
 
 
  lang_hooks.function.final (f);
  lang_hooks.function.final (f);
}
}
 
 
/* Clear out all parts of the state in F that can safely be discarded
/* Clear out all parts of the state in F that can safely be discarded
   after the function has been compiled, to let garbage collection
   after the function has been compiled, to let garbage collection
   reclaim the memory.  */
   reclaim the memory.  */
 
 
void
void
free_after_compilation (struct function *f)
free_after_compilation (struct function *f)
{
{
  VEC_free (int, heap, prologue);
  VEC_free (int, heap, prologue);
  VEC_free (int, heap, epilogue);
  VEC_free (int, heap, epilogue);
  VEC_free (int, heap, sibcall_epilogue);
  VEC_free (int, heap, sibcall_epilogue);
 
 
  f->eh = NULL;
  f->eh = NULL;
  f->expr = NULL;
  f->expr = NULL;
  f->emit = NULL;
  f->emit = NULL;
  f->varasm = NULL;
  f->varasm = NULL;
  f->machine = NULL;
  f->machine = NULL;
  f->cfg = NULL;
  f->cfg = NULL;
 
 
  f->x_avail_temp_slots = NULL;
  f->x_avail_temp_slots = NULL;
  f->x_used_temp_slots = NULL;
  f->x_used_temp_slots = NULL;
  f->arg_offset_rtx = NULL;
  f->arg_offset_rtx = NULL;
  f->return_rtx = NULL;
  f->return_rtx = NULL;
  f->internal_arg_pointer = NULL;
  f->internal_arg_pointer = NULL;
  f->x_nonlocal_goto_handler_labels = NULL;
  f->x_nonlocal_goto_handler_labels = NULL;
  f->x_return_label = NULL;
  f->x_return_label = NULL;
  f->x_naked_return_label = NULL;
  f->x_naked_return_label = NULL;
  f->x_stack_slot_list = NULL;
  f->x_stack_slot_list = NULL;
  f->x_stack_check_probe_note = NULL;
  f->x_stack_check_probe_note = NULL;
  f->x_arg_pointer_save_area = NULL;
  f->x_arg_pointer_save_area = NULL;
  f->x_parm_birth_insn = NULL;
  f->x_parm_birth_insn = NULL;
  f->epilogue_delay_list = NULL;
  f->epilogue_delay_list = NULL;
}
}


/* Allocate fixed slots in the stack frame of the current function.  */
/* Allocate fixed slots in the stack frame of the current function.  */
 
 
/* Return size needed for stack frame based on slots so far allocated in
/* Return size needed for stack frame based on slots so far allocated in
   function F.
   function F.
   This size counts from zero.  It is not rounded to PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY;
   This size counts from zero.  It is not rounded to PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY;
   the caller may have to do that.  */
   the caller may have to do that.  */
 
 
static HOST_WIDE_INT
static HOST_WIDE_INT
get_func_frame_size (struct function *f)
get_func_frame_size (struct function *f)
{
{
  if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
  if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
    return -f->x_frame_offset;
    return -f->x_frame_offset;
  else
  else
    return f->x_frame_offset;
    return f->x_frame_offset;
}
}
 
 
/* Return size needed for stack frame based on slots so far allocated.
/* Return size needed for stack frame based on slots so far allocated.
   This size counts from zero.  It is not rounded to PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY;
   This size counts from zero.  It is not rounded to PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY;
   the caller may have to do that.  */
   the caller may have to do that.  */
 
 
HOST_WIDE_INT
HOST_WIDE_INT
get_frame_size (void)
get_frame_size (void)
{
{
  return get_func_frame_size (cfun);
  return get_func_frame_size (cfun);
}
}
 
 
/* Issue an error message and return TRUE if frame OFFSET overflows in
/* Issue an error message and return TRUE if frame OFFSET overflows in
   the signed target pointer arithmetics for function FUNC.  Otherwise
   the signed target pointer arithmetics for function FUNC.  Otherwise
   return FALSE.  */
   return FALSE.  */
 
 
bool
bool
frame_offset_overflow (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, tree func)
frame_offset_overflow (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, tree func)
{
{
  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size = FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD ? -offset : offset;
  unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size = FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD ? -offset : offset;
 
 
  if (size > ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (Pmode) - 1))
  if (size > ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (Pmode) - 1))
               /* Leave room for the fixed part of the frame.  */
               /* Leave room for the fixed part of the frame.  */
               - 64 * UNITS_PER_WORD)
               - 64 * UNITS_PER_WORD)
    {
    {
      error ("%Jtotal size of local objects too large", func);
      error ("%Jtotal size of local objects too large", func);
      return TRUE;
      return TRUE;
    }
    }
 
 
  return FALSE;
  return FALSE;
}
}
 
 
/* Allocate a stack slot of SIZE bytes and return a MEM rtx for it
/* Allocate a stack slot of SIZE bytes and return a MEM rtx for it
   with machine mode MODE.
   with machine mode MODE.
 
 
   ALIGN controls the amount of alignment for the address of the slot:
   ALIGN controls the amount of alignment for the address of the slot:
   0 means according to MODE,
   0 means according to MODE,
   -1 means use BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT and round size to multiple of that,
   -1 means use BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT and round size to multiple of that,
   -2 means use BITS_PER_UNIT,
   -2 means use BITS_PER_UNIT,
   positive specifies alignment boundary in bits.
   positive specifies alignment boundary in bits.
 
 
   We do not round to stack_boundary here.
   We do not round to stack_boundary here.
 
 
   FUNCTION specifies the function to allocate in.  */
   FUNCTION specifies the function to allocate in.  */
 
 
static rtx
static rtx
assign_stack_local_1 (enum machine_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT size, int align,
assign_stack_local_1 (enum machine_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT size, int align,
                      struct function *function)
                      struct function *function)
{
{
  rtx x, addr;
  rtx x, addr;
  int bigend_correction = 0;
  int bigend_correction = 0;
  unsigned int alignment;
  unsigned int alignment;
  int frame_off, frame_alignment, frame_phase;
  int frame_off, frame_alignment, frame_phase;
 
 
  if (align == 0)
  if (align == 0)
    {
    {
      tree type;
      tree type;
 
 
      if (mode == BLKmode)
      if (mode == BLKmode)
        alignment = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
        alignment = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
      else
      else
        alignment = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
        alignment = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
 
 
      /* Allow the target to (possibly) increase the alignment of this
      /* Allow the target to (possibly) increase the alignment of this
         stack slot.  */
         stack slot.  */
      type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 0);
      type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 0);
      if (type)
      if (type)
        alignment = LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (type, alignment);
        alignment = LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (type, alignment);
 
 
      alignment /= BITS_PER_UNIT;
      alignment /= BITS_PER_UNIT;
    }
    }
  else if (align == -1)
  else if (align == -1)
    {
    {
      alignment = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
      alignment = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
      size = CEIL_ROUND (size, alignment);
      size = CEIL_ROUND (size, alignment);
    }
    }
  else if (align == -2)
  else if (align == -2)
    alignment = 1; /* BITS_PER_UNIT / BITS_PER_UNIT */
    alignment = 1; /* BITS_PER_UNIT / BITS_PER_UNIT */
  else
  else
    alignment = align / BITS_PER_UNIT;
    alignment = align / BITS_PER_UNIT;
 
 
  if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
  if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
    function->x_frame_offset -= size;
    function->x_frame_offset -= size;
 
 
  /* Ignore alignment we can't do with expected alignment of the boundary.  */
  /* Ignore alignment we can't do with expected alignment of the boundary.  */
  if (alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT > PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY)
  if (alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT > PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY)
    alignment = PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT;
    alignment = PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT;
 
 
  if (function->stack_alignment_needed < alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT)
  if (function->stack_alignment_needed < alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT)
    function->stack_alignment_needed = alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT;
    function->stack_alignment_needed = alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT;
 
 
  /* Calculate how many bytes the start of local variables is off from
  /* Calculate how many bytes the start of local variables is off from
     stack alignment.  */
     stack alignment.  */
  frame_alignment = PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT;
  frame_alignment = PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT;
  frame_off = STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET % frame_alignment;
  frame_off = STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET % frame_alignment;
  frame_phase = frame_off ? frame_alignment - frame_off : 0;
  frame_phase = frame_off ? frame_alignment - frame_off : 0;
 
 
  /* Round the frame offset to the specified alignment.  The default is
  /* Round the frame offset to the specified alignment.  The default is
     to always honor requests to align the stack but a port may choose to
     to always honor requests to align the stack but a port may choose to
     do its own stack alignment by defining STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED.  */
     do its own stack alignment by defining STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED.  */
  if (STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
  if (STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
      || mode != BLKmode
      || mode != BLKmode
      || size != 0)
      || size != 0)
    {
    {
      /*  We must be careful here, since FRAME_OFFSET might be negative and
      /*  We must be careful here, since FRAME_OFFSET might be negative and
          division with a negative dividend isn't as well defined as we might
          division with a negative dividend isn't as well defined as we might
          like.  So we instead assume that ALIGNMENT is a power of two and
          like.  So we instead assume that ALIGNMENT is a power of two and
          use logical operations which are unambiguous.  */
          use logical operations which are unambiguous.  */
      if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
      if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
        function->x_frame_offset
        function->x_frame_offset
          = (FLOOR_ROUND (function->x_frame_offset - frame_phase,
          = (FLOOR_ROUND (function->x_frame_offset - frame_phase,
                          (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) alignment)
                          (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) alignment)
             + frame_phase);
             + frame_phase);
      else
      else
        function->x_frame_offset
        function->x_frame_offset
          = (CEIL_ROUND (function->x_frame_offset - frame_phase,
          = (CEIL_ROUND (function->x_frame_offset - frame_phase,
                         (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) alignment)
                         (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) alignment)
             + frame_phase);
             + frame_phase);
    }
    }
 
 
  /* On a big-endian machine, if we are allocating more space than we will use,
  /* On a big-endian machine, if we are allocating more space than we will use,
     use the least significant bytes of those that are allocated.  */
     use the least significant bytes of those that are allocated.  */
  if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && mode != BLKmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < size)
  if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && mode != BLKmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < size)
    bigend_correction = size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
    bigend_correction = size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
 
 
  /* If we have already instantiated virtual registers, return the actual
  /* If we have already instantiated virtual registers, return the actual
     address relative to the frame pointer.  */
     address relative to the frame pointer.  */
  if (function == cfun && virtuals_instantiated)
  if (function == cfun && virtuals_instantiated)
    addr = plus_constant (frame_pointer_rtx,
    addr = plus_constant (frame_pointer_rtx,
                          trunc_int_for_mode
                          trunc_int_for_mode
                          (frame_offset + bigend_correction
                          (frame_offset + bigend_correction
                           + STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET, Pmode));
                           + STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET, Pmode));
  else
  else
    addr = plus_constant (virtual_stack_vars_rtx,
    addr = plus_constant (virtual_stack_vars_rtx,
                          trunc_int_for_mode
                          trunc_int_for_mode
                          (function->x_frame_offset + bigend_correction,
                          (function->x_frame_offset + bigend_correction,
                           Pmode));
                           Pmode));
 
 
  if (!FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
  if (!FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
    function->x_frame_offset += size;
    function->x_frame_offset += size;
 
 
  x = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
  x = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
  MEM_NOTRAP_P (x) = 1;
  MEM_NOTRAP_P (x) = 1;
 
 
  function->x_stack_slot_list
  function->x_stack_slot_list
    = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, function->x_stack_slot_list);
    = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, function->x_stack_slot_list);
 
 
  if (frame_offset_overflow (function->x_frame_offset, function->decl))
  if (frame_offset_overflow (function->x_frame_offset, function->decl))
    function->x_frame_offset = 0;
    function->x_frame_offset = 0;
 
 
  return x;
  return x;
}
}
 
 
/* Wrapper around assign_stack_local_1;  assign a local stack slot for the
/* Wrapper around assign_stack_local_1;  assign a local stack slot for the
   current function.  */
   current function.  */
 
 
rtx
rtx
assign_stack_local (enum machine_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT size, int align)
assign_stack_local (enum machine_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT size, int align)
{
{
  return assign_stack_local_1 (mode, size, align, cfun);
  return assign_stack_local_1 (mode, size, align, cfun);
}
}
 
 


/* Removes temporary slot TEMP from LIST.  */
/* Removes temporary slot TEMP from LIST.  */
 
 
static void
static void
cut_slot_from_list (struct temp_slot *temp, struct temp_slot **list)
cut_slot_from_list (struct temp_slot *temp, struct temp_slot **list)
{
{
  if (temp->next)
  if (temp->next)
    temp->next->prev = temp->prev;
    temp->next->prev = temp->prev;
  if (temp->prev)
  if (temp->prev)
    temp->prev->next = temp->next;
    temp->prev->next = temp->next;
  else
  else
    *list = temp->next;
    *list = temp->next;
 
 
  temp->prev = temp->next = NULL;
  temp->prev = temp->next = NULL;
}
}
 
 
/* Inserts temporary slot TEMP to LIST.  */
/* Inserts temporary slot TEMP to LIST.  */
 
 
static void
static void
insert_slot_to_list (struct temp_slot *temp, struct temp_slot **list)
insert_slot_to_list (struct temp_slot *temp, struct temp_slot **list)
{
{
  temp->next = *list;
  temp->next = *list;
  if (*list)
  if (*list)
    (*list)->prev = temp;
    (*list)->prev = temp;
  temp->prev = NULL;
  temp->prev = NULL;
  *list = temp;
  *list = temp;
}
}
 
 
/* Returns the list of used temp slots at LEVEL.  */
/* Returns the list of used temp slots at LEVEL.  */
 
 
static struct temp_slot **
static struct temp_slot **
temp_slots_at_level (int level)
temp_slots_at_level (int level)
{
{
  if (level >= (int) VEC_length (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots))
  if (level >= (int) VEC_length (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots))
    {
    {
      size_t old_length = VEC_length (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots);
      size_t old_length = VEC_length (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots);
      temp_slot_p *p;
      temp_slot_p *p;
 
 
      VEC_safe_grow (temp_slot_p, gc, used_temp_slots, level + 1);
      VEC_safe_grow (temp_slot_p, gc, used_temp_slots, level + 1);
      p = VEC_address (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots);
      p = VEC_address (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots);
      memset (&p[old_length], 0,
      memset (&p[old_length], 0,
              sizeof (temp_slot_p) * (level + 1 - old_length));
              sizeof (temp_slot_p) * (level + 1 - old_length));
    }
    }
 
 
  return &(VEC_address (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots)[level]);
  return &(VEC_address (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots)[level]);
}
}
 
 
/* Returns the maximal temporary slot level.  */
/* Returns the maximal temporary slot level.  */
 
 
static int
static int
max_slot_level (void)
max_slot_level (void)
{
{
  if (!used_temp_slots)
  if (!used_temp_slots)
    return -1;
    return -1;
 
 
  return VEC_length (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots) - 1;
  return VEC_length (temp_slot_p, used_temp_slots) - 1;
}
}
 
 
/* Moves temporary slot TEMP to LEVEL.  */
/* Moves temporary slot TEMP to LEVEL.  */
 
 
static void
static void
move_slot_to_level (struct temp_slot *temp, int level)
move_slot_to_level (struct temp_slot *temp, int level)
{
{
  cut_slot_from_list (temp, temp_slots_at_level (temp->level));
  cut_slot_from_list (temp, temp_slots_at_level (temp->level));
  insert_slot_to_list (temp, temp_slots_at_level (level));
  insert_slot_to_list (temp, temp_slots_at_level (level));
  temp->level = level;
  temp->level = level;
}
}
 
 
/* Make temporary slot TEMP available.  */
/* Make temporary slot TEMP available.  */
 
 
static void
static void
make_slot_available (struct temp_slot *temp)
make_slot_available (struct temp_slot *temp)
{
{
  cut_slot_from_list (temp, temp_slots_at_level (temp->level));
  cut_slot_from_list (temp, temp_slots_at_level (temp->level));
  insert_slot_to_list (temp, &avail_temp_slots);
  insert_slot_to_list (temp, &avail_temp_slots);
  temp->in_use = 0;
  temp->in_use = 0;
  temp->level = -1;
  temp->level = -1;
}
}


/* Allocate a temporary stack slot and record it for possible later
/* Allocate a temporary stack slot and record it for possible later
   reuse.
   reuse.
 
 
   MODE is the machine mode to be given to the returned rtx.
   MODE is the machine mode to be given to the returned rtx.
 
 
   SIZE is the size in units of the space required.  We do no rounding here
   SIZE is the size in units of the space required.  We do no rounding here
   since assign_stack_local will do any required rounding.
   since assign_stack_local will do any required rounding.
 
 
   KEEP is 1 if this slot is to be retained after a call to
   KEEP is 1 if this slot is to be retained after a call to
   free_temp_slots.  Automatic variables for a block are allocated
   free_temp_slots.  Automatic variables for a block are allocated
   with this flag.  KEEP values of 2 or 3 were needed respectively
   with this flag.  KEEP values of 2 or 3 were needed respectively
   for variables whose lifetime is controlled by CLEANUP_POINT_EXPRs
   for variables whose lifetime is controlled by CLEANUP_POINT_EXPRs
   or for SAVE_EXPRs, but they are now unused.
   or for SAVE_EXPRs, but they are now unused.
 
 
   TYPE is the type that will be used for the stack slot.  */
   TYPE is the type that will be used for the stack slot.  */
 
 
rtx
rtx
assign_stack_temp_for_type (enum machine_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT size,
assign_stack_temp_for_type (enum machine_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT size,
                            int keep, tree type)
                            int keep, tree type)
{
{
  unsigned int align;
  unsigned int align;
  struct temp_slot *p, *best_p = 0, *selected = NULL, **pp;
  struct temp_slot *p, *best_p = 0, *selected = NULL, **pp;
  rtx slot;
  rtx slot;
 
 
  /* If SIZE is -1 it means that somebody tried to allocate a temporary
  /* If SIZE is -1 it means that somebody tried to allocate a temporary
     of a variable size.  */
     of a variable size.  */
  gcc_assert (size != -1);
  gcc_assert (size != -1);
 
 
  /* These are now unused.  */
  /* These are now unused.  */
  gcc_assert (keep <= 1);
  gcc_assert (keep <= 1);
 
 
  if (mode == BLKmode)
  if (mode == BLKmode)
    align = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
    align = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
  else
  else
    align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
    align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
 
 
  if (! type)
  if (! type)
    type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 0);
    type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 0);
 
 
  if (type)
  if (type)
    align = LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (type, align);
    align = LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (type, align);
 
 
  /* Try to find an available, already-allocated temporary of the proper
  /* Try to find an available, already-allocated temporary of the proper
     mode which meets the size and alignment requirements.  Choose the
     mode which meets the size and alignment requirements.  Choose the
     smallest one with the closest alignment.
     smallest one with the closest alignment.
 
 
     If assign_stack_temp is called outside of the tree->rtl expansion,
     If assign_stack_temp is called outside of the tree->rtl expansion,
     we cannot reuse the stack slots (that may still refer to
     we cannot reuse the stack slots (that may still refer to
     VIRTUAL_STACK_VARS_REGNUM).  */
     VIRTUAL_STACK_VARS_REGNUM).  */
  if (!virtuals_instantiated)
  if (!virtuals_instantiated)
    {
    {
      for (p = avail_temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
      for (p = avail_temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
        {
        {
          if (p->align >= align && p->size >= size
          if (p->align >= align && p->size >= size
              && GET_MODE (p->slot) == mode
              && GET_MODE (p->slot) == mode
              && objects_must_conflict_p (p->type, type)
              && objects_must_conflict_p (p->type, type)
              && (best_p == 0 || best_p->size > p->size
              && (best_p == 0 || best_p->size > p->size
                  || (best_p->size == p->size && best_p->align > p->align)))
                  || (best_p->size == p->size && best_p->align > p->align)))
            {
            {
              if (p->align == align && p->size == size)
              if (p->align == align && p->size == size)
                {
                {
                  selected = p;
                  selected = p;
                  cut_slot_from_list (selected, &avail_temp_slots);
                  cut_slot_from_list (selected, &avail_temp_slots);
                  best_p = 0;
                  best_p = 0;
                  break;
                  break;
                }
                }
              best_p = p;
              best_p = p;
            }
            }
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Make our best, if any, the one to use.  */
  /* Make our best, if any, the one to use.  */
  if (best_p)
  if (best_p)
    {
    {
      selected = best_p;
      selected = best_p;
      cut_slot_from_list (selected, &avail_temp_slots);
      cut_slot_from_list (selected, &avail_temp_slots);
 
 
      /* If there are enough aligned bytes left over, make them into a new
      /* If there are enough aligned bytes left over, make them into a new
         temp_slot so that the extra bytes don't get wasted.  Do this only
         temp_slot so that the extra bytes don't get wasted.  Do this only
         for BLKmode slots, so that we can be sure of the alignment.  */
         for BLKmode slots, so that we can be sure of the alignment.  */
      if (GET_MODE (best_p->slot) == BLKmode)
      if (GET_MODE (best_p->slot) == BLKmode)
        {
        {
          int alignment = best_p->align / BITS_PER_UNIT;
          int alignment = best_p->align / BITS_PER_UNIT;
          HOST_WIDE_INT rounded_size = CEIL_ROUND (size, alignment);
          HOST_WIDE_INT rounded_size = CEIL_ROUND (size, alignment);
 
 
          if (best_p->size - rounded_size >= alignment)
          if (best_p->size - rounded_size >= alignment)
            {
            {
              p = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct temp_slot));
              p = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct temp_slot));
              p->in_use = p->addr_taken = 0;
              p->in_use = p->addr_taken = 0;
              p->size = best_p->size - rounded_size;
              p->size = best_p->size - rounded_size;
              p->base_offset = best_p->base_offset + rounded_size;
              p->base_offset = best_p->base_offset + rounded_size;
              p->full_size = best_p->full_size - rounded_size;
              p->full_size = best_p->full_size - rounded_size;
              p->slot = adjust_address_nv (best_p->slot, BLKmode, rounded_size);
              p->slot = adjust_address_nv (best_p->slot, BLKmode, rounded_size);
              p->align = best_p->align;
              p->align = best_p->align;
              p->address = 0;
              p->address = 0;
              p->type = best_p->type;
              p->type = best_p->type;
              insert_slot_to_list (p, &avail_temp_slots);
              insert_slot_to_list (p, &avail_temp_slots);
 
 
              stack_slot_list = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, p->slot,
              stack_slot_list = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, p->slot,
                                                   stack_slot_list);
                                                   stack_slot_list);
 
 
              best_p->size = rounded_size;
              best_p->size = rounded_size;
              best_p->full_size = rounded_size;
              best_p->full_size = rounded_size;
            }
            }
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  /* If we still didn't find one, make a new temporary.  */
  /* If we still didn't find one, make a new temporary.  */
  if (selected == 0)
  if (selected == 0)
    {
    {
      HOST_WIDE_INT frame_offset_old = frame_offset;
      HOST_WIDE_INT frame_offset_old = frame_offset;
 
 
      p = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct temp_slot));
      p = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct temp_slot));
 
 
      /* We are passing an explicit alignment request to assign_stack_local.
      /* We are passing an explicit alignment request to assign_stack_local.
         One side effect of that is assign_stack_local will not round SIZE
         One side effect of that is assign_stack_local will not round SIZE
         to ensure the frame offset remains suitably aligned.
         to ensure the frame offset remains suitably aligned.
 
 
         So for requests which depended on the rounding of SIZE, we go ahead
         So for requests which depended on the rounding of SIZE, we go ahead
         and round it now.  We also make sure ALIGNMENT is at least
         and round it now.  We also make sure ALIGNMENT is at least
         BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.  */
         BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.  */
      gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode || align == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
      gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode || align == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
      p->slot = assign_stack_local (mode,
      p->slot = assign_stack_local (mode,
                                    (mode == BLKmode
                                    (mode == BLKmode
                                     ? CEIL_ROUND (size, (int) align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
                                     ? CEIL_ROUND (size, (int) align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
                                     : size),
                                     : size),
                                    align);
                                    align);
 
 
      p->align = align;
      p->align = align;
 
 
      /* The following slot size computation is necessary because we don't
      /* The following slot size computation is necessary because we don't
         know the actual size of the temporary slot until assign_stack_local
         know the actual size of the temporary slot until assign_stack_local
         has performed all the frame alignment and size rounding for the
         has performed all the frame alignment and size rounding for the
         requested temporary.  Note that extra space added for alignment
         requested temporary.  Note that extra space added for alignment
         can be either above or below this stack slot depending on which
         can be either above or below this stack slot depending on which
         way the frame grows.  We include the extra space if and only if it
         way the frame grows.  We include the extra space if and only if it
         is above this slot.  */
         is above this slot.  */
      if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
      if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
        p->size = frame_offset_old - frame_offset;
        p->size = frame_offset_old - frame_offset;
      else
      else
        p->size = size;
        p->size = size;
 
 
      /* Now define the fields used by combine_temp_slots.  */
      /* Now define the fields used by combine_temp_slots.  */
      if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
      if (FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
        {
        {
          p->base_offset = frame_offset;
          p->base_offset = frame_offset;
          p->full_size = frame_offset_old - frame_offset;
          p->full_size = frame_offset_old - frame_offset;
        }
        }
      else
      else
        {
        {
          p->base_offset = frame_offset_old;
          p->base_offset = frame_offset_old;
          p->full_size = frame_offset - frame_offset_old;
          p->full_size = frame_offset - frame_offset_old;
        }
        }
      p->address = 0;
      p->address = 0;
 
 
      selected = p;
      selected = p;
    }
    }
 
 
  p = selected;
  p = selected;
  p->in_use = 1;
  p->in_use = 1;
  p->addr_taken = 0;
  p->addr_taken = 0;
  p->type = type;
  p->type = type;
  p->level = temp_slot_level;
  p->level = temp_slot_level;
  p->keep = keep;
  p->keep = keep;
 
 
  pp = temp_slots_at_level (p->level);
  pp = temp_slots_at_level (p->level);
  insert_slot_to_list (p, pp);
  insert_slot_to_list (p, pp);
 
 
  /* Create a new MEM rtx to avoid clobbering MEM flags of old slots.  */
  /* Create a new MEM rtx to avoid clobbering MEM flags of old slots.  */
  slot = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, XEXP (p->slot, 0));
  slot = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, XEXP (p->slot, 0));
  stack_slot_list = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, slot, stack_slot_list);
  stack_slot_list = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, slot, stack_slot_list);
 
 
  /* If we know the alias set for the memory that will be used, use
  /* If we know the alias set for the memory that will be used, use
     it.  If there's no TYPE, then we don't know anything about the
     it.  If there's no TYPE, then we don't know anything about the
     alias set for the memory.  */
     alias set for the memory.  */
  set_mem_alias_set (slot, type ? get_alias_set (type) : 0);
  set_mem_alias_set (slot, type ? get_alias_set (type) : 0);
  set_mem_align (slot, align);
  set_mem_align (slot, align);
 
 
  /* If a type is specified, set the relevant flags.  */
  /* If a type is specified, set the relevant flags.  */
  if (type != 0)
  if (type != 0)
    {
    {
      MEM_VOLATILE_P (slot) = TYPE_VOLATILE (type);
      MEM_VOLATILE_P (slot) = TYPE_VOLATILE (type);
      MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (slot, AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type));
      MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (slot, AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type));
    }
    }
  MEM_NOTRAP_P (slot) = 1;
  MEM_NOTRAP_P (slot) = 1;
 
 
  return slot;
  return slot;
}
}
 
 
/* Allocate a temporary stack slot and record it for possible later
/* Allocate a temporary stack slot and record it for possible later
   reuse.  First three arguments are same as in preceding function.  */
   reuse.  First three arguments are same as in preceding function.  */
 
 
rtx
rtx
assign_stack_temp (enum machine_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT size, int keep)
assign_stack_temp (enum machine_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT size, int keep)
{
{
  return assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, size, keep, NULL_TREE);
  return assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, size, keep, NULL_TREE);
}
}


/* Assign a temporary.
/* Assign a temporary.
   If TYPE_OR_DECL is a decl, then we are doing it on behalf of the decl
   If TYPE_OR_DECL is a decl, then we are doing it on behalf of the decl
   and so that should be used in error messages.  In either case, we
   and so that should be used in error messages.  In either case, we
   allocate of the given type.
   allocate of the given type.
   KEEP is as for assign_stack_temp.
   KEEP is as for assign_stack_temp.
   MEMORY_REQUIRED is 1 if the result must be addressable stack memory;
   MEMORY_REQUIRED is 1 if the result must be addressable stack memory;
   it is 0 if a register is OK.
   it is 0 if a register is OK.
   DONT_PROMOTE is 1 if we should not promote values in register
   DONT_PROMOTE is 1 if we should not promote values in register
   to wider modes.  */
   to wider modes.  */
 
 
rtx
rtx
assign_temp (tree type_or_decl, int keep, int memory_required,
assign_temp (tree type_or_decl, int keep, int memory_required,
             int dont_promote ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
             int dont_promote ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
{
{
  tree type, decl;
  tree type, decl;
  enum machine_mode mode;
  enum machine_mode mode;
#ifdef PROMOTE_MODE
#ifdef PROMOTE_MODE
  int unsignedp;
  int unsignedp;
#endif
#endif
 
 
  if (DECL_P (type_or_decl))
  if (DECL_P (type_or_decl))
    decl = type_or_decl, type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
    decl = type_or_decl, type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
  else
  else
    decl = NULL, type = type_or_decl;
    decl = NULL, type = type_or_decl;
 
 
  mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
  mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
#ifdef PROMOTE_MODE
#ifdef PROMOTE_MODE
  unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
  unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
#endif
#endif
 
 
  if (mode == BLKmode || memory_required)
  if (mode == BLKmode || memory_required)
    {
    {
      HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
      HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
      rtx tmp;
      rtx tmp;
 
 
      /* Zero sized arrays are GNU C extension.  Set size to 1 to avoid
      /* Zero sized arrays are GNU C extension.  Set size to 1 to avoid
         problems with allocating the stack space.  */
         problems with allocating the stack space.  */
      if (size == 0)
      if (size == 0)
        size = 1;
        size = 1;
 
 
      /* Unfortunately, we don't yet know how to allocate variable-sized
      /* Unfortunately, we don't yet know how to allocate variable-sized
         temporaries.  However, sometimes we can find a fixed upper limit on
         temporaries.  However, sometimes we can find a fixed upper limit on
         the size, so try that instead.  */
         the size, so try that instead.  */
      else if (size == -1)
      else if (size == -1)
        size = max_int_size_in_bytes (type);
        size = max_int_size_in_bytes (type);
 
 
      /* The size of the temporary may be too large to fit into an integer.  */
      /* The size of the temporary may be too large to fit into an integer.  */
      /* ??? Not sure this should happen except for user silliness, so limit
      /* ??? Not sure this should happen except for user silliness, so limit
         this to things that aren't compiler-generated temporaries.  The
         this to things that aren't compiler-generated temporaries.  The
         rest of the time we'll die in assign_stack_temp_for_type.  */
         rest of the time we'll die in assign_stack_temp_for_type.  */
      if (decl && size == -1
      if (decl && size == -1
          && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
          && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
        {
        {
          error ("size of variable %q+D is too large", decl);
          error ("size of variable %q+D is too large", decl);
          size = 1;
          size = 1;
        }
        }
 
 
      tmp = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, size, keep, type);
      tmp = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, size, keep, type);
      return tmp;
      return tmp;
    }
    }
 
 
#ifdef PROMOTE_MODE
#ifdef PROMOTE_MODE
  if (! dont_promote)
  if (! dont_promote)
    mode = promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp, 0);
    mode = promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp, 0);
#endif
#endif
 
 
  return gen_reg_rtx (mode);
  return gen_reg_rtx (mode);
}
}


/* Combine temporary stack slots which are adjacent on the stack.
/* Combine temporary stack slots which are adjacent on the stack.
 
 
   This allows for better use of already allocated stack space.  This is only
   This allows for better use of already allocated stack space.  This is only
   done for BLKmode slots because we can be sure that we won't have alignment
   done for BLKmode slots because we can be sure that we won't have alignment
   problems in this case.  */
   problems in this case.  */
 
 
static void
static void
combine_temp_slots (void)
combine_temp_slots (void)
{
{
  struct temp_slot *p, *q, *next, *next_q;
  struct temp_slot *p, *q, *next, *next_q;
  int num_slots;
  int num_slots;
 
 
  /* We can't combine slots, because the information about which slot
  /* We can't combine slots, because the information about which slot
     is in which alias set will be lost.  */
     is in which alias set will be lost.  */
  if (flag_strict_aliasing)
  if (flag_strict_aliasing)
    return;
    return;
 
 
  /* If there are a lot of temp slots, don't do anything unless
  /* If there are a lot of temp slots, don't do anything unless
     high levels of optimization.  */
     high levels of optimization.  */
  if (! flag_expensive_optimizations)
  if (! flag_expensive_optimizations)
    for (p = avail_temp_slots, num_slots = 0; p; p = p->next, num_slots++)
    for (p = avail_temp_slots, num_slots = 0; p; p = p->next, num_slots++)
      if (num_slots > 100 || (num_slots > 10 && optimize == 0))
      if (num_slots > 100 || (num_slots > 10 && optimize == 0))
        return;
        return;
 
 
  for (p = avail_temp_slots; p; p = next)
  for (p = avail_temp_slots; p; p = next)
    {
    {
      int delete_p = 0;
      int delete_p = 0;
 
 
      next = p->next;
      next = p->next;
 
 
      if (GET_MODE (p->slot) != BLKmode)
      if (GET_MODE (p->slot) != BLKmode)
        continue;
        continue;
 
 
      for (q = p->next; q; q = next_q)
      for (q = p->next; q; q = next_q)
        {
        {
          int delete_q = 0;
          int delete_q = 0;
 
 
          next_q = q->next;
          next_q = q->next;
 
 
          if (GET_MODE (q->slot) != BLKmode)
          if (GET_MODE (q->slot) != BLKmode)
            continue;
            continue;
 
 
          if (p->base_offset + p->full_size == q->base_offset)
          if (p->base_offset + p->full_size == q->base_offset)
            {
            {
              /* Q comes after P; combine Q into P.  */
              /* Q comes after P; combine Q into P.  */
              p->size += q->size;
              p->size += q->size;
              p->full_size += q->full_size;
              p->full_size += q->full_size;
              delete_q = 1;
              delete_q = 1;
            }
            }
          else if (q->base_offset + q->full_size == p->base_offset)
          else if (q->base_offset + q->full_size == p->base_offset)
            {
            {
              /* P comes after Q; combine P into Q.  */
              /* P comes after Q; combine P into Q.  */
              q->size += p->size;
              q->size += p->size;
              q->full_size += p->full_size;
              q->full_size += p->full_size;
              delete_p = 1;
              delete_p = 1;
              break;
              break;
            }
            }
          if (delete_q)
          if (delete_q)
            cut_slot_from_list (q, &avail_temp_slots);
            cut_slot_from_list (q, &avail_temp_slots);
        }
        }
 
 
      /* Either delete P or advance past it.  */
      /* Either delete P or advance past it.  */
      if (delete_p)
      if (delete_p)
        cut_slot_from_list (p, &avail_temp_slots);
        cut_slot_from_list (p, &avail_temp_slots);
    }
    }
}
}


/* Find the temp slot corresponding to the object at address X.  */
/* Find the temp slot corresponding to the object at address X.  */
 
 
static struct temp_slot *
static struct temp_slot *
find_temp_slot_from_address (rtx x)
find_temp_slot_from_address (rtx x)
{
{
  struct temp_slot *p;
  struct temp_slot *p;
  rtx next;
  rtx next;
  int i;
  int i;
 
 
  for (i = max_slot_level (); i >= 0; i--)
  for (i = max_slot_level (); i >= 0; i--)
    for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (i); p; p = p->next)
    for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (i); p; p = p->next)
      {
      {
        if (XEXP (p->slot, 0) == x
        if (XEXP (p->slot, 0) == x
            || p->address == x
            || p->address == x
            || (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
            || (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
                && XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx
                && XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx
                && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
                && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
                && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= p->base_offset
                && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= p->base_offset
                && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) < p->base_offset + p->full_size))
                && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) < p->base_offset + p->full_size))
          return p;
          return p;
 
 
        else if (p->address != 0 && GET_CODE (p->address) == EXPR_LIST)
        else if (p->address != 0 && GET_CODE (p->address) == EXPR_LIST)
          for (next = p->address; next; next = XEXP (next, 1))
          for (next = p->address; next; next = XEXP (next, 1))
            if (XEXP (next, 0) == x)
            if (XEXP (next, 0) == x)
              return p;
              return p;
      }
      }
 
 
  /* If we have a sum involving a register, see if it points to a temp
  /* If we have a sum involving a register, see if it points to a temp
     slot.  */
     slot.  */
  if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
  if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
      && (p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0))) != 0)
      && (p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0))) != 0)
    return p;
    return p;
  else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && REG_P (XEXP (x, 1))
  else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && REG_P (XEXP (x, 1))
           && (p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 1))) != 0)
           && (p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 1))) != 0)
    return p;
    return p;
 
 
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}
 
 
/* Indicate that NEW is an alternate way of referring to the temp slot
/* Indicate that NEW is an alternate way of referring to the temp slot
   that previously was known by OLD.  */
   that previously was known by OLD.  */
 
 
void
void
update_temp_slot_address (rtx old, rtx new)
update_temp_slot_address (rtx old, rtx new)
{
{
  struct temp_slot *p;
  struct temp_slot *p;
 
 
  if (rtx_equal_p (old, new))
  if (rtx_equal_p (old, new))
    return;
    return;
 
 
  p = find_temp_slot_from_address (old);
  p = find_temp_slot_from_address (old);
 
 
  /* If we didn't find one, see if both OLD is a PLUS.  If so, and NEW
  /* If we didn't find one, see if both OLD is a PLUS.  If so, and NEW
     is a register, see if one operand of the PLUS is a temporary
     is a register, see if one operand of the PLUS is a temporary
     location.  If so, NEW points into it.  Otherwise, if both OLD and
     location.  If so, NEW points into it.  Otherwise, if both OLD and
     NEW are a PLUS and if there is a register in common between them.
     NEW are a PLUS and if there is a register in common between them.
     If so, try a recursive call on those values.  */
     If so, try a recursive call on those values.  */
  if (p == 0)
  if (p == 0)
    {
    {
      if (GET_CODE (old) != PLUS)
      if (GET_CODE (old) != PLUS)
        return;
        return;
 
 
      if (REG_P (new))
      if (REG_P (new))
        {
        {
          update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 0), new);
          update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 0), new);
          update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 1), new);
          update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 1), new);
          return;
          return;
        }
        }
      else if (GET_CODE (new) != PLUS)
      else if (GET_CODE (new) != PLUS)
        return;
        return;
 
 
      if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 0)))
      if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 0)))
        update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 1));
        update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 1));
      else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 0)))
      else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 0)))
        update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 1));
        update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 1));
      else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 1)))
      else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 1)))
        update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 0));
        update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 0));
      else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 1)))
      else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 1)))
        update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 0));
        update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 0));
 
 
      return;
      return;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Otherwise add an alias for the temp's address.  */
  /* Otherwise add an alias for the temp's address.  */
  else if (p->address == 0)
  else if (p->address == 0)
    p->address = new;
    p->address = new;
  else
  else
    {
    {
      if (GET_CODE (p->address) != EXPR_LIST)
      if (GET_CODE (p->address) != EXPR_LIST)
        p->address = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, p->address, NULL_RTX);
        p->address = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, p->address, NULL_RTX);
 
 
      p->address = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, new, p->address);
      p->address = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, new, p->address);
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
/* If X could be a reference to a temporary slot, mark the fact that its
/* If X could be a reference to a temporary slot, mark the fact that its
   address was taken.  */
   address was taken.  */
 
 
void
void
mark_temp_addr_taken (rtx x)
mark_temp_addr_taken (rtx x)
{
{
  struct temp_slot *p;
  struct temp_slot *p;
 
 
  if (x == 0)
  if (x == 0)
    return;
    return;
 
 
  /* If X is not in memory or is at a constant address, it cannot be in
  /* If X is not in memory or is at a constant address, it cannot be in
     a temporary slot.  */
     a temporary slot.  */
  if (!MEM_P (x) || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
  if (!MEM_P (x) || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
    return;
    return;
 
 
  p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0));
  p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0));
  if (p != 0)
  if (p != 0)
    p->addr_taken = 1;
    p->addr_taken = 1;
}
}
 
 
/* If X could be a reference to a temporary slot, mark that slot as
/* If X could be a reference to a temporary slot, mark that slot as
   belonging to the to one level higher than the current level.  If X
   belonging to the to one level higher than the current level.  If X
   matched one of our slots, just mark that one.  Otherwise, we can't
   matched one of our slots, just mark that one.  Otherwise, we can't
   easily predict which it is, so upgrade all of them.  Kept slots
   easily predict which it is, so upgrade all of them.  Kept slots
   need not be touched.
   need not be touched.
 
 
   This is called when an ({...}) construct occurs and a statement
   This is called when an ({...}) construct occurs and a statement
   returns a value in memory.  */
   returns a value in memory.  */
 
 
void
void
preserve_temp_slots (rtx x)
preserve_temp_slots (rtx x)
{
{
  struct temp_slot *p = 0, *next;
  struct temp_slot *p = 0, *next;
 
 
  /* If there is no result, we still might have some objects whose address
  /* If there is no result, we still might have some objects whose address
     were taken, so we need to make sure they stay around.  */
     were taken, so we need to make sure they stay around.  */
  if (x == 0)
  if (x == 0)
    {
    {
      for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
      for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
        {
        {
          next = p->next;
          next = p->next;
 
 
          if (p->addr_taken)
          if (p->addr_taken)
            move_slot_to_level (p, temp_slot_level - 1);
            move_slot_to_level (p, temp_slot_level - 1);
        }
        }
 
 
      return;
      return;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* If X is a register that is being used as a pointer, see if we have
  /* If X is a register that is being used as a pointer, see if we have
     a temporary slot we know it points to.  To be consistent with
     a temporary slot we know it points to.  To be consistent with
     the code below, we really should preserve all non-kept slots
     the code below, we really should preserve all non-kept slots
     if we can't find a match, but that seems to be much too costly.  */
     if we can't find a match, but that seems to be much too costly.  */
  if (REG_P (x) && REG_POINTER (x))
  if (REG_P (x) && REG_POINTER (x))
    p = find_temp_slot_from_address (x);
    p = find_temp_slot_from_address (x);
 
 
  /* If X is not in memory or is at a constant address, it cannot be in
  /* If X is not in memory or is at a constant address, it cannot be in
     a temporary slot, but it can contain something whose address was
     a temporary slot, but it can contain something whose address was
     taken.  */
     taken.  */
  if (p == 0 && (!MEM_P (x) || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))))
  if (p == 0 && (!MEM_P (x) || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))))
    {
    {
      for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
      for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
        {
        {
          next = p->next;
          next = p->next;
 
 
          if (p->addr_taken)
          if (p->addr_taken)
            move_slot_to_level (p, temp_slot_level - 1);
            move_slot_to_level (p, temp_slot_level - 1);
        }
        }
 
 
      return;
      return;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* First see if we can find a match.  */
  /* First see if we can find a match.  */
  if (p == 0)
  if (p == 0)
    p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0));
    p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0));
 
 
  if (p != 0)
  if (p != 0)
    {
    {
      /* Move everything at our level whose address was taken to our new
      /* Move everything at our level whose address was taken to our new
         level in case we used its address.  */
         level in case we used its address.  */
      struct temp_slot *q;
      struct temp_slot *q;
 
 
      if (p->level == temp_slot_level)
      if (p->level == temp_slot_level)
        {
        {
          for (q = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); q; q = next)
          for (q = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); q; q = next)
            {
            {
              next = q->next;
              next = q->next;
 
 
              if (p != q && q->addr_taken)
              if (p != q && q->addr_taken)
                move_slot_to_level (q, temp_slot_level - 1);
                move_slot_to_level (q, temp_slot_level - 1);
            }
            }
 
 
          move_slot_to_level (p, temp_slot_level - 1);
          move_slot_to_level (p, temp_slot_level - 1);
          p->addr_taken = 0;
          p->addr_taken = 0;
        }
        }
      return;
      return;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Otherwise, preserve all non-kept slots at this level.  */
  /* Otherwise, preserve all non-kept slots at this level.  */
  for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
  for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
    {
    {
      next = p->next;
      next = p->next;
 
 
      if (!p->keep)
      if (!p->keep)
        move_slot_to_level (p, temp_slot_level - 1);
        move_slot_to_level (p, temp_slot_level - 1);
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
/* Free all temporaries used so far.  This is normally called at the
/* Free all temporaries used so far.  This is normally called at the
   end of generating code for a statement.  */
   end of generating code for a statement.  */
 
 
void
void
free_temp_slots (void)
free_temp_slots (void)
{
{
  struct temp_slot *p, *next;
  struct temp_slot *p, *next;
 
 
  for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
  for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
    {
    {
      next = p->next;
      next = p->next;
 
 
      if (!p->keep)
      if (!p->keep)
        make_slot_available (p);
        make_slot_available (p);
    }
    }
 
 
  combine_temp_slots ();
  combine_temp_slots ();
}
}
 
 
/* Push deeper into the nesting level for stack temporaries.  */
/* Push deeper into the nesting level for stack temporaries.  */
 
 
void
void
push_temp_slots (void)
push_temp_slots (void)
{
{
  temp_slot_level++;
  temp_slot_level++;
}
}
 
 
/* Pop a temporary nesting level.  All slots in use in the current level
/* Pop a temporary nesting level.  All slots in use in the current level
   are freed.  */
   are freed.  */
 
 
void
void
pop_temp_slots (void)
pop_temp_slots (void)
{
{
  struct temp_slot *p, *next;
  struct temp_slot *p, *next;
 
 
  for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
  for (p = *temp_slots_at_level (temp_slot_level); p; p = next)
    {
    {
      next = p->next;
      next = p->next;
      make_slot_available (p);
      make_slot_available (p);
    }
    }
 
 
  combine_temp_slots ();
  combine_temp_slots ();
 
 
  temp_slot_level--;
  temp_slot_level--;
}
}
 
 
/* Initialize temporary slots.  */
/* Initialize temporary slots.  */
 
 
void
void
init_temp_slots (void)
init_temp_slots (void)
{
{
  /* We have not allocated any temporaries yet.  */
  /* We have not allocated any temporaries yet.  */
  avail_temp_slots = 0;
  avail_temp_slots = 0;
  used_temp_slots = 0;
  used_temp_slots = 0;
  temp_slot_level = 0;
  temp_slot_level = 0;
}
}


/* These routines are responsible for converting virtual register references
/* These routines are responsible for converting virtual register references
   to the actual hard register references once RTL generation is complete.
   to the actual hard register references once RTL generation is complete.
 
 
   The following four variables are used for communication between the
   The following four variables are used for communication between the
   routines.  They contain the offsets of the virtual registers from their
   routines.  They contain the offsets of the virtual registers from their
   respective hard registers.  */
   respective hard registers.  */
 
 
static int in_arg_offset;
static int in_arg_offset;
static int var_offset;
static int var_offset;
static int dynamic_offset;
static int dynamic_offset;
static int out_arg_offset;
static int out_arg_offset;
static int cfa_offset;
static int cfa_offset;
 
 
/* In most machines, the stack pointer register is equivalent to the bottom
/* In most machines, the stack pointer register is equivalent to the bottom
   of the stack.  */
   of the stack.  */
 
 
#ifndef STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
#ifndef STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
#define STACK_POINTER_OFFSET    0
#define STACK_POINTER_OFFSET    0
#endif
#endif
 
 
/* If not defined, pick an appropriate default for the offset of dynamically
/* If not defined, pick an appropriate default for the offset of dynamically
   allocated memory depending on the value of ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS,
   allocated memory depending on the value of ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS,
   REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE, and OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE.  */
   REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE, and OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE.  */
 
 
#ifndef STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
#ifndef STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
 
 
/* The bottom of the stack points to the actual arguments.  If
/* The bottom of the stack points to the actual arguments.  If
   REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is defined, this includes the space for the register
   REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is defined, this includes the space for the register
   parameters.  However, if OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK space is not defined,
   parameters.  However, if OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK space is not defined,
   stack space for register parameters is not pushed by the caller, but
   stack space for register parameters is not pushed by the caller, but
   rather part of the fixed stack areas and hence not included in
   rather part of the fixed stack areas and hence not included in
   `current_function_outgoing_args_size'.  Nevertheless, we must allow
   `current_function_outgoing_args_size'.  Nevertheless, we must allow
   for it when allocating stack dynamic objects.  */
   for it when allocating stack dynamic objects.  */
 
 
#if defined(REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE) && ! defined(OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
#if defined(REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE) && ! defined(OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
#define STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET(FNDECL)    \
#define STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET(FNDECL)    \
((ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS                                                    \
((ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS                                                    \
  ? (current_function_outgoing_args_size + REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (FNDECL)) : 0)\
  ? (current_function_outgoing_args_size + REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (FNDECL)) : 0)\
 + (STACK_POINTER_OFFSET))                                                    \
 + (STACK_POINTER_OFFSET))                                                    \
 
 
#else
#else
#define STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET(FNDECL)    \
#define STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET(FNDECL)    \
((ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS ? current_function_outgoing_args_size : 0)          \
((ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS ? current_function_outgoing_args_size : 0)          \
 + (STACK_POINTER_OFFSET))
 + (STACK_POINTER_OFFSET))
#endif
#endif
#endif
#endif
 
 


/* Given a piece of RTX and a pointer to a HOST_WIDE_INT, if the RTX
/* Given a piece of RTX and a pointer to a HOST_WIDE_INT, if the RTX
   is a virtual register, return the equivalent hard register and set the
   is a virtual register, return the equivalent hard register and set the
   offset indirectly through the pointer.  Otherwise, return 0.  */
   offset indirectly through the pointer.  Otherwise, return 0.  */
 
 
static rtx
static rtx
instantiate_new_reg (rtx x, HOST_WIDE_INT *poffset)
instantiate_new_reg (rtx x, HOST_WIDE_INT *poffset)
{
{
  rtx new;
  rtx new;
  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
 
 
  if (x == virtual_incoming_args_rtx)
  if (x == virtual_incoming_args_rtx)
    new = arg_pointer_rtx, offset = in_arg_offset;
    new = arg_pointer_rtx, offset = in_arg_offset;
  else if (x == virtual_stack_vars_rtx)
  else if (x == virtual_stack_vars_rtx)
    new = frame_pointer_rtx, offset = var_offset;
    new = frame_pointer_rtx, offset = var_offset;
  else if (x == virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx)
  else if (x == virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx)
    new = stack_pointer_rtx, offset = dynamic_offset;
    new = stack_pointer_rtx, offset = dynamic_offset;
  else if (x == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx)
  else if (x == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx)
    new = stack_pointer_rtx, offset = out_arg_offset;
    new = stack_pointer_rtx, offset = out_arg_offset;
  else if (x == virtual_cfa_rtx)
  else if (x == virtual_cfa_rtx)
    {
    {
#ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
#ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
      new = frame_pointer_rtx;
      new = frame_pointer_rtx;
#else
#else
      new = arg_pointer_rtx;
      new = arg_pointer_rtx;
#endif
#endif
      offset = cfa_offset;
      offset = cfa_offset;
    }
    }
  else
  else
    return NULL_RTX;
    return NULL_RTX;
 
 
  *poffset = offset;
  *poffset = offset;
  return new;
  return new;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of instantiate_virtual_regs, called via for_each_rtx.
/* A subroutine of instantiate_virtual_regs, called via for_each_rtx.
   Instantiate any virtual registers present inside of *LOC.  The expression
   Instantiate any virtual registers present inside of *LOC.  The expression
   is simplified, as much as possible, but is not to be considered "valid"
   is simplified, as much as possible, but is not to be considered "valid"
   in any sense implied by the target.  If any change is made, set CHANGED
   in any sense implied by the target.  If any change is made, set CHANGED
   to true.  */
   to true.  */
 
 
static int
static int
instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx (rtx *loc, void *data)
instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx (rtx *loc, void *data)
{
{
  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
  bool *changed = (bool *) data;
  bool *changed = (bool *) data;
  rtx x, new;
  rtx x, new;
 
 
  x = *loc;
  x = *loc;
  if (x == 0)
  if (x == 0)
    return 0;
    return 0;
 
 
  switch (GET_CODE (x))
  switch (GET_CODE (x))
    {
    {
    case REG:
    case REG:
      new = instantiate_new_reg (x, &offset);
      new = instantiate_new_reg (x, &offset);
      if (new)
      if (new)
        {
        {
          *loc = plus_constant (new, offset);
          *loc = plus_constant (new, offset);
          if (changed)
          if (changed)
            *changed = true;
            *changed = true;
        }
        }
      return -1;
      return -1;
 
 
    case PLUS:
    case PLUS:
      new = instantiate_new_reg (XEXP (x, 0), &offset);
      new = instantiate_new_reg (XEXP (x, 0), &offset);
      if (new)
      if (new)
        {
        {
          new = plus_constant (new, offset);
          new = plus_constant (new, offset);
          *loc = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, GET_MODE (x), new, XEXP (x, 1));
          *loc = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, GET_MODE (x), new, XEXP (x, 1));
          if (changed)
          if (changed)
            *changed = true;
            *changed = true;
          return -1;
          return -1;
        }
        }
 
 
      /* FIXME -- from old code */
      /* FIXME -- from old code */
          /* If we have (plus (subreg (virtual-reg)) (const_int)), we know
          /* If we have (plus (subreg (virtual-reg)) (const_int)), we know
             we can commute the PLUS and SUBREG because pointers into the
             we can commute the PLUS and SUBREG because pointers into the
             frame are well-behaved.  */
             frame are well-behaved.  */
      break;
      break;
 
 
    default:
    default:
      break;
      break;
    }
    }
 
 
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of instantiate_virtual_regs_in_insn.  Return true if X
/* A subroutine of instantiate_virtual_regs_in_insn.  Return true if X
   matches the predicate for insn CODE operand OPERAND.  */
   matches the predicate for insn CODE operand OPERAND.  */
 
 
static int
static int
safe_insn_predicate (int code, int operand, rtx x)
safe_insn_predicate (int code, int operand, rtx x)
{
{
  const struct insn_operand_data *op_data;
  const struct insn_operand_data *op_data;
 
 
  if (code < 0)
  if (code < 0)
    return true;
    return true;
 
 
  op_data = &insn_data[code].operand[operand];
  op_data = &insn_data[code].operand[operand];
  if (op_data->predicate == NULL)
  if (op_data->predicate == NULL)
    return true;
    return true;
 
 
  return op_data->predicate (x, op_data->mode);
  return op_data->predicate (x, op_data->mode);
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of instantiate_virtual_regs.  Instantiate any virtual
/* A subroutine of instantiate_virtual_regs.  Instantiate any virtual
   registers present inside of insn.  The result will be a valid insn.  */
   registers present inside of insn.  The result will be a valid insn.  */
 
 
static void
static void
instantiate_virtual_regs_in_insn (rtx insn)
instantiate_virtual_regs_in_insn (rtx insn)
{
{
  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
  HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
  int insn_code, i;
  int insn_code, i;
  bool any_change = false;
  bool any_change = false;
  rtx set, new, x, seq;
  rtx set, new, x, seq;
 
 
  /* There are some special cases to be handled first.  */
  /* There are some special cases to be handled first.  */
  set = single_set (insn);
  set = single_set (insn);
  if (set)
  if (set)
    {
    {
      /* We're allowed to assign to a virtual register.  This is interpreted
      /* We're allowed to assign to a virtual register.  This is interpreted
         to mean that the underlying register gets assigned the inverse
         to mean that the underlying register gets assigned the inverse
         transformation.  This is used, for example, in the handling of
         transformation.  This is used, for example, in the handling of
         non-local gotos.  */
         non-local gotos.  */
      new = instantiate_new_reg (SET_DEST (set), &offset);
      new = instantiate_new_reg (SET_DEST (set), &offset);
      if (new)
      if (new)
        {
        {
          start_sequence ();
          start_sequence ();
 
 
          for_each_rtx (&SET_SRC (set), instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, NULL);
          for_each_rtx (&SET_SRC (set), instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, NULL);
          x = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, GET_MODE (new), SET_SRC (set),
          x = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, GET_MODE (new), SET_SRC (set),
                                   GEN_INT (-offset));
                                   GEN_INT (-offset));
          x = force_operand (x, new);
          x = force_operand (x, new);
          if (x != new)
          if (x != new)
            emit_move_insn (new, x);
            emit_move_insn (new, x);
 
 
          seq = get_insns ();
          seq = get_insns ();
          end_sequence ();
          end_sequence ();
 
 
          emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
          emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
          delete_insn (insn);
          delete_insn (insn);
          return;
          return;
        }
        }
 
 
      /* Handle a straight copy from a virtual register by generating a
      /* Handle a straight copy from a virtual register by generating a
         new add insn.  The difference between this and falling through
         new add insn.  The difference between this and falling through
         to the generic case is avoiding a new pseudo and eliminating a
         to the generic case is avoiding a new pseudo and eliminating a
         move insn in the initial rtl stream.  */
         move insn in the initial rtl stream.  */
      new = instantiate_new_reg (SET_SRC (set), &offset);
      new = instantiate_new_reg (SET_SRC (set), &offset);
      if (new && offset != 0
      if (new && offset != 0
          && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
          && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
          && REGNO (SET_DEST (set)) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
          && REGNO (SET_DEST (set)) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
        {
        {
          start_sequence ();
          start_sequence ();
 
 
          x = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)), PLUS,
          x = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)), PLUS,
                                   new, GEN_INT (offset), SET_DEST (set),
                                   new, GEN_INT (offset), SET_DEST (set),
                                   1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
                                   1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
          if (x != SET_DEST (set))
          if (x != SET_DEST (set))
            emit_move_insn (SET_DEST (set), x);
            emit_move_insn (SET_DEST (set), x);
 
 
          seq = get_insns ();
          seq = get_insns ();
          end_sequence ();
          end_sequence ();
 
 
          emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
          emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
          delete_insn (insn);
          delete_insn (insn);
          return;
          return;
        }
        }
 
 
      extract_insn (insn);
      extract_insn (insn);
      insn_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
      insn_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
 
 
      /* Handle a plus involving a virtual register by determining if the
      /* Handle a plus involving a virtual register by determining if the
         operands remain valid if they're modified in place.  */
         operands remain valid if they're modified in place.  */
      if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
      if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
          && recog_data.n_operands >= 3
          && recog_data.n_operands >= 3
          && recog_data.operand_loc[1] == &XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0)
          && recog_data.operand_loc[1] == &XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0)
          && recog_data.operand_loc[2] == &XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)
          && recog_data.operand_loc[2] == &XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)
          && GET_CODE (recog_data.operand[2]) == CONST_INT
          && GET_CODE (recog_data.operand[2]) == CONST_INT
          && (new = instantiate_new_reg (recog_data.operand[1], &offset)))
          && (new = instantiate_new_reg (recog_data.operand[1], &offset)))
        {
        {
          offset += INTVAL (recog_data.operand[2]);
          offset += INTVAL (recog_data.operand[2]);
 
 
          /* If the sum is zero, then replace with a plain move.  */
          /* If the sum is zero, then replace with a plain move.  */
          if (offset == 0
          if (offset == 0
              && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
              && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
              && REGNO (SET_DEST (set)) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
              && REGNO (SET_DEST (set)) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
            {
            {
              start_sequence ();
              start_sequence ();
              emit_move_insn (SET_DEST (set), new);
              emit_move_insn (SET_DEST (set), new);
              seq = get_insns ();
              seq = get_insns ();
              end_sequence ();
              end_sequence ();
 
 
              emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
              emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
              delete_insn (insn);
              delete_insn (insn);
              return;
              return;
            }
            }
 
 
          x = gen_int_mode (offset, recog_data.operand_mode[2]);
          x = gen_int_mode (offset, recog_data.operand_mode[2]);
 
 
          /* Using validate_change and apply_change_group here leaves
          /* Using validate_change and apply_change_group here leaves
             recog_data in an invalid state.  Since we know exactly what
             recog_data in an invalid state.  Since we know exactly what
             we want to check, do those two by hand.  */
             we want to check, do those two by hand.  */
          if (safe_insn_predicate (insn_code, 1, new)
          if (safe_insn_predicate (insn_code, 1, new)
              && safe_insn_predicate (insn_code, 2, x))
              && safe_insn_predicate (insn_code, 2, x))
            {
            {
              *recog_data.operand_loc[1] = recog_data.operand[1] = new;
              *recog_data.operand_loc[1] = recog_data.operand[1] = new;
              *recog_data.operand_loc[2] = recog_data.operand[2] = x;
              *recog_data.operand_loc[2] = recog_data.operand[2] = x;
              any_change = true;
              any_change = true;
 
 
              /* Fall through into the regular operand fixup loop in
              /* Fall through into the regular operand fixup loop in
                 order to take care of operands other than 1 and 2.  */
                 order to take care of operands other than 1 and 2.  */
            }
            }
        }
        }
    }
    }
  else
  else
    {
    {
      extract_insn (insn);
      extract_insn (insn);
      insn_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
      insn_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
    }
    }
 
 
  /* In the general case, we expect virtual registers to appear only in
  /* In the general case, we expect virtual registers to appear only in
     operands, and then only as either bare registers or inside memories.  */
     operands, and then only as either bare registers or inside memories.  */
  for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; ++i)
  for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; ++i)
    {
    {
      x = recog_data.operand[i];
      x = recog_data.operand[i];
      switch (GET_CODE (x))
      switch (GET_CODE (x))
        {
        {
        case MEM:
        case MEM:
          {
          {
            rtx addr = XEXP (x, 0);
            rtx addr = XEXP (x, 0);
            bool changed = false;
            bool changed = false;
 
 
            for_each_rtx (&addr, instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, &changed);
            for_each_rtx (&addr, instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, &changed);
            if (!changed)
            if (!changed)
              continue;
              continue;
 
 
            start_sequence ();
            start_sequence ();
            x = replace_equiv_address (x, addr);
            x = replace_equiv_address (x, addr);
            seq = get_insns ();
            seq = get_insns ();
            end_sequence ();
            end_sequence ();
            if (seq)
            if (seq)
              emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
              emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
          }
          }
          break;
          break;
 
 
        case REG:
        case REG:
          new = instantiate_new_reg (x, &offset);
          new = instantiate_new_reg (x, &offset);
          if (new == NULL)
          if (new == NULL)
            continue;
            continue;
          if (offset == 0)
          if (offset == 0)
            x = new;
            x = new;
          else
          else
            {
            {
              start_sequence ();
              start_sequence ();
 
 
              /* Careful, special mode predicates may have stuff in
              /* Careful, special mode predicates may have stuff in
                 insn_data[insn_code].operand[i].mode that isn't useful
                 insn_data[insn_code].operand[i].mode that isn't useful
                 to us for computing a new value.  */
                 to us for computing a new value.  */
              /* ??? Recognize address_operand and/or "p" constraints
              /* ??? Recognize address_operand and/or "p" constraints
                 to see if (plus new offset) is a valid before we put
                 to see if (plus new offset) is a valid before we put
                 this through expand_simple_binop.  */
                 this through expand_simple_binop.  */
              x = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (x), PLUS, new,
              x = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (x), PLUS, new,
                                       GEN_INT (offset), NULL_RTX,
                                       GEN_INT (offset), NULL_RTX,
                                       1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
                                       1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
              seq = get_insns ();
              seq = get_insns ();
              end_sequence ();
              end_sequence ();
              emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
              emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
            }
            }
          break;
          break;
 
 
        case SUBREG:
        case SUBREG:
          new = instantiate_new_reg (SUBREG_REG (x), &offset);
          new = instantiate_new_reg (SUBREG_REG (x), &offset);
          if (new == NULL)
          if (new == NULL)
            continue;
            continue;
          if (offset != 0)
          if (offset != 0)
            {
            {
              start_sequence ();
              start_sequence ();
              new = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (new), PLUS, new,
              new = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (new), PLUS, new,
                                         GEN_INT (offset), NULL_RTX,
                                         GEN_INT (offset), NULL_RTX,
                                         1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
                                         1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
              seq = get_insns ();
              seq = get_insns ();
              end_sequence ();
              end_sequence ();
              emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
              emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
            }
            }
          x = simplify_gen_subreg (recog_data.operand_mode[i], new,
          x = simplify_gen_subreg (recog_data.operand_mode[i], new,
                                   GET_MODE (new), SUBREG_BYTE (x));
                                   GET_MODE (new), SUBREG_BYTE (x));
          break;
          break;
 
 
        default:
        default:
          continue;
          continue;
        }
        }
 
 
      /* At this point, X contains the new value for the operand.
      /* At this point, X contains the new value for the operand.
         Validate the new value vs the insn predicate.  Note that
         Validate the new value vs the insn predicate.  Note that
         asm insns will have insn_code -1 here.  */
         asm insns will have insn_code -1 here.  */
      if (!safe_insn_predicate (insn_code, i, x))
      if (!safe_insn_predicate (insn_code, i, x))
        {
        {
          start_sequence ();
          start_sequence ();
          x = force_reg (insn_data[insn_code].operand[i].mode, x);
          x = force_reg (insn_data[insn_code].operand[i].mode, x);
          seq = get_insns ();
          seq = get_insns ();
          end_sequence ();
          end_sequence ();
          if (seq)
          if (seq)
            emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
            emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
        }
        }
 
 
      *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = recog_data.operand[i] = x;
      *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = recog_data.operand[i] = x;
      any_change = true;
      any_change = true;
    }
    }
 
 
  if (any_change)
  if (any_change)
    {
    {
      /* Propagate operand changes into the duplicates.  */
      /* Propagate operand changes into the duplicates.  */
      for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; ++i)
      for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; ++i)
        *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
        *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
          = recog_data.operand[(unsigned)recog_data.dup_num[i]];
          = recog_data.operand[(unsigned)recog_data.dup_num[i]];
 
 
      /* Force re-recognition of the instruction for validation.  */
      /* Force re-recognition of the instruction for validation.  */
      INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
      INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
    }
    }
 
 
  if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
  if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
    {
    {
      if (!check_asm_operands (PATTERN (insn)))
      if (!check_asm_operands (PATTERN (insn)))
        {
        {
          error_for_asm (insn, "impossible constraint in %<asm%>");
          error_for_asm (insn, "impossible constraint in %<asm%>");
          delete_insn (insn);
          delete_insn (insn);
        }
        }
    }
    }
  else
  else
    {
    {
      if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
      if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
        fatal_insn_not_found (insn);
        fatal_insn_not_found (insn);
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
/* Subroutine of instantiate_decls.  Given RTL representing a decl,
/* Subroutine of instantiate_decls.  Given RTL representing a decl,
   do any instantiation required.  */
   do any instantiation required.  */
 
 
static void
static void
instantiate_decl (rtx x)
instantiate_decl (rtx x)
{
{
  rtx addr;
  rtx addr;
 
 
  if (x == 0)
  if (x == 0)
    return;
    return;
 
 
  /* If this is a CONCAT, recurse for the pieces.  */
  /* If this is a CONCAT, recurse for the pieces.  */
  if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT)
  if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT)
    {
    {
      instantiate_decl (XEXP (x, 0));
      instantiate_decl (XEXP (x, 0));
      instantiate_decl (XEXP (x, 1));
      instantiate_decl (XEXP (x, 1));
      return;
      return;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* If this is not a MEM, no need to do anything.  Similarly if the
  /* If this is not a MEM, no need to do anything.  Similarly if the
     address is a constant or a register that is not a virtual register.  */
     address is a constant or a register that is not a virtual register.  */
  if (!MEM_P (x))
  if (!MEM_P (x))
    return;
    return;
 
 
  addr = XEXP (x, 0);
  addr = XEXP (x, 0);
  if (CONSTANT_P (addr)
  if (CONSTANT_P (addr)
      || (REG_P (addr)
      || (REG_P (addr)
          && (REGNO (addr) < FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
          && (REGNO (addr) < FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
              || REGNO (addr) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)))
              || REGNO (addr) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)))
    return;
    return;
 
 
  for_each_rtx (&XEXP (x, 0), instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, NULL);
  for_each_rtx (&XEXP (x, 0), instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, NULL);
}
}
 
 
/* Helper for instantiate_decls called via walk_tree: Process all decls
/* Helper for instantiate_decls called via walk_tree: Process all decls
   in the given DECL_VALUE_EXPR.  */
   in the given DECL_VALUE_EXPR.  */
 
 
static tree
static tree
instantiate_expr (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
instantiate_expr (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
{
{
  tree t = *tp;
  tree t = *tp;
  if (! EXPR_P (t))
  if (! EXPR_P (t))
    {
    {
      *walk_subtrees = 0;
      *walk_subtrees = 0;
      if (DECL_P (t) && DECL_RTL_SET_P (t))
      if (DECL_P (t) && DECL_RTL_SET_P (t))
        instantiate_decl (DECL_RTL (t));
        instantiate_decl (DECL_RTL (t));
    }
    }
  return NULL;
  return NULL;
}
}
 
 
/* Subroutine of instantiate_decls: Process all decls in the given
/* Subroutine of instantiate_decls: Process all decls in the given
   BLOCK node and all its subblocks.  */
   BLOCK node and all its subblocks.  */
 
 
static void
static void
instantiate_decls_1 (tree let)
instantiate_decls_1 (tree let)
{
{
  tree t;
  tree t;
 
 
  for (t = BLOCK_VARS (let); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
  for (t = BLOCK_VARS (let); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
    {
    {
      if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (t))
      if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (t))
        instantiate_decl (DECL_RTL (t));
        instantiate_decl (DECL_RTL (t));
      if (TREE_CODE (t) == VAR_DECL && DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (t))
      if (TREE_CODE (t) == VAR_DECL && DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (t))
        {
        {
          tree v = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (t);
          tree v = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (t);
          walk_tree (&v, instantiate_expr, NULL, NULL);
          walk_tree (&v, instantiate_expr, NULL, NULL);
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Process all subblocks.  */
  /* Process all subblocks.  */
  for (t = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (let); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
  for (t = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (let); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
    instantiate_decls_1 (t);
    instantiate_decls_1 (t);
}
}
 
 
/* Scan all decls in FNDECL (both variables and parameters) and instantiate
/* Scan all decls in FNDECL (both variables and parameters) and instantiate
   all virtual registers in their DECL_RTL's.  */
   all virtual registers in their DECL_RTL's.  */
 
 
static void
static void
instantiate_decls (tree fndecl)
instantiate_decls (tree fndecl)
{
{
  tree decl;
  tree decl;
 
 
  /* Process all parameters of the function.  */
  /* Process all parameters of the function.  */
  for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
  for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
    {
    {
      instantiate_decl (DECL_RTL (decl));
      instantiate_decl (DECL_RTL (decl));
      instantiate_decl (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl));
      instantiate_decl (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl));
      if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl))
      if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl))
        {
        {
          tree v = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
          tree v = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
          walk_tree (&v, instantiate_expr, NULL, NULL);
          walk_tree (&v, instantiate_expr, NULL, NULL);
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Now process all variables defined in the function or its subblocks.  */
  /* Now process all variables defined in the function or its subblocks.  */
  instantiate_decls_1 (DECL_INITIAL (fndecl));
  instantiate_decls_1 (DECL_INITIAL (fndecl));
}
}
 
 
/* Pass through the INSNS of function FNDECL and convert virtual register
/* Pass through the INSNS of function FNDECL and convert virtual register
   references to hard register references.  */
   references to hard register references.  */
 
 
static unsigned int
static unsigned int
instantiate_virtual_regs (void)
instantiate_virtual_regs (void)
{
{
  rtx insn;
  rtx insn;
 
 
  /* Compute the offsets to use for this function.  */
  /* Compute the offsets to use for this function.  */
  in_arg_offset = FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
  in_arg_offset = FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
  var_offset = STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET;
  var_offset = STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET;
  dynamic_offset = STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
  dynamic_offset = STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
  out_arg_offset = STACK_POINTER_OFFSET;
  out_arg_offset = STACK_POINTER_OFFSET;
#ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
#ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
  cfa_offset = FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
  cfa_offset = FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
#else
#else
  cfa_offset = ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
  cfa_offset = ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
#endif
#endif
 
 
  /* Initialize recognition, indicating that volatile is OK.  */
  /* Initialize recognition, indicating that volatile is OK.  */
  init_recog ();
  init_recog ();
 
 
  /* Scan through all the insns, instantiating every virtual register still
  /* Scan through all the insns, instantiating every virtual register still
     present.  */
     present.  */
  for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
  for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
    if (INSN_P (insn))
    if (INSN_P (insn))
      {
      {
        /* These patterns in the instruction stream can never be recognized.
        /* These patterns in the instruction stream can never be recognized.
           Fortunately, they shouldn't contain virtual registers either.  */
           Fortunately, they shouldn't contain virtual registers either.  */
        if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
        if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
            || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
            || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
            || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_VEC
            || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_VEC
            || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
            || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
            || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT)
            || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT)
          continue;
          continue;
 
 
        instantiate_virtual_regs_in_insn (insn);
        instantiate_virtual_regs_in_insn (insn);
 
 
        if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn))
        if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn))
          continue;
          continue;
 
 
        for_each_rtx (&REG_NOTES (insn), instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, NULL);
        for_each_rtx (&REG_NOTES (insn), instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, NULL);
 
 
        /* Instantiate any virtual registers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.  */
        /* Instantiate any virtual registers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.  */
        if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
        if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
          for_each_rtx (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
          for_each_rtx (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
                        instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, NULL);
                        instantiate_virtual_regs_in_rtx, NULL);
      }
      }
 
 
  /* Instantiate the virtual registers in the DECLs for debugging purposes.  */
  /* Instantiate the virtual registers in the DECLs for debugging purposes.  */
  instantiate_decls (current_function_decl);
  instantiate_decls (current_function_decl);
 
 
  /* Indicate that, from now on, assign_stack_local should use
  /* Indicate that, from now on, assign_stack_local should use
     frame_pointer_rtx.  */
     frame_pointer_rtx.  */
  virtuals_instantiated = 1;
  virtuals_instantiated = 1;
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}
 
 
struct tree_opt_pass pass_instantiate_virtual_regs =
struct tree_opt_pass pass_instantiate_virtual_regs =
{
{
  "vregs",                              /* name */
  "vregs",                              /* name */
  NULL,                                 /* gate */
  NULL,                                 /* gate */
  instantiate_virtual_regs,             /* execute */
  instantiate_virtual_regs,             /* execute */
  NULL,                                 /* sub */
  NULL,                                 /* sub */
  NULL,                                 /* next */
  NULL,                                 /* next */
  0,                                    /* static_pass_number */
  0,                                    /* static_pass_number */
  0,                                    /* tv_id */
  0,                                    /* tv_id */
  0,                                    /* properties_required */
  0,                                    /* properties_required */
  0,                                    /* properties_provided */
  0,                                    /* properties_provided */
  0,                                    /* properties_destroyed */
  0,                                    /* properties_destroyed */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_start */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_start */
  TODO_dump_func,                       /* todo_flags_finish */
  TODO_dump_func,                       /* todo_flags_finish */
  0                                     /* letter */
  0                                     /* letter */
};
};
 
 


/* Return 1 if EXP is an aggregate type (or a value with aggregate type).
/* Return 1 if EXP is an aggregate type (or a value with aggregate type).
   This means a type for which function calls must pass an address to the
   This means a type for which function calls must pass an address to the
   function or get an address back from the function.
   function or get an address back from the function.
   EXP may be a type node or an expression (whose type is tested).  */
   EXP may be a type node or an expression (whose type is tested).  */
 
 
int
int
aggregate_value_p (tree exp, tree fntype)
aggregate_value_p (tree exp, tree fntype)
{
{
  int i, regno, nregs;
  int i, regno, nregs;
  rtx reg;
  rtx reg;
 
 
  tree type = (TYPE_P (exp)) ? exp : TREE_TYPE (exp);
  tree type = (TYPE_P (exp)) ? exp : TREE_TYPE (exp);
 
 
  /* DECL node associated with FNTYPE when relevant, which we might need to
  /* DECL node associated with FNTYPE when relevant, which we might need to
     check for by-invisible-reference returns, typically for CALL_EXPR input
     check for by-invisible-reference returns, typically for CALL_EXPR input
     EXPressions.  */
     EXPressions.  */
  tree fndecl = NULL_TREE;
  tree fndecl = NULL_TREE;
 
 
  if (fntype)
  if (fntype)
    switch (TREE_CODE (fntype))
    switch (TREE_CODE (fntype))
      {
      {
      case CALL_EXPR:
      case CALL_EXPR:
        fndecl = get_callee_fndecl (fntype);
        fndecl = get_callee_fndecl (fntype);
        fntype = fndecl ? TREE_TYPE (fndecl) : 0;
        fntype = fndecl ? TREE_TYPE (fndecl) : 0;
        break;
        break;
      case FUNCTION_DECL:
      case FUNCTION_DECL:
        fndecl = fntype;
        fndecl = fntype;
        fntype = TREE_TYPE (fndecl);
        fntype = TREE_TYPE (fndecl);
        break;
        break;
      case FUNCTION_TYPE:
      case FUNCTION_TYPE:
      case METHOD_TYPE:
      case METHOD_TYPE:
        break;
        break;
      case IDENTIFIER_NODE:
      case IDENTIFIER_NODE:
        fntype = 0;
        fntype = 0;
        break;
        break;
      default:
      default:
        /* We don't expect other rtl types here.  */
        /* We don't expect other rtl types here.  */
        gcc_unreachable ();
        gcc_unreachable ();
      }
      }
 
 
  if (TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
  if (TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
    return 0;
    return 0;
 
 
  /* If the front end has decided that this needs to be passed by
  /* If the front end has decided that this needs to be passed by
     reference, do so.  */
     reference, do so.  */
  if ((TREE_CODE (exp) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (exp) == RESULT_DECL)
  if ((TREE_CODE (exp) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (exp) == RESULT_DECL)
      && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (exp))
      && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (exp))
    return 1;
    return 1;
 
 
  /* If the EXPression is a CALL_EXPR, honor DECL_BY_REFERENCE set on the
  /* If the EXPression is a CALL_EXPR, honor DECL_BY_REFERENCE set on the
     called function RESULT_DECL, meaning the function returns in memory by
     called function RESULT_DECL, meaning the function returns in memory by
     invisible reference.  This check lets front-ends not set TREE_ADDRESSABLE
     invisible reference.  This check lets front-ends not set TREE_ADDRESSABLE
     on the function type, which used to be the way to request such a return
     on the function type, which used to be the way to request such a return
     mechanism but might now be causing troubles at gimplification time if
     mechanism but might now be causing troubles at gimplification time if
     temporaries with the function type need to be created.  */
     temporaries with the function type need to be created.  */
  if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR && fndecl && DECL_RESULT (fndecl)
  if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR && fndecl && DECL_RESULT (fndecl)
      && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (DECL_RESULT (fndecl)))
      && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (DECL_RESULT (fndecl)))
    return 1;
    return 1;
 
 
  if (targetm.calls.return_in_memory (type, fntype))
  if (targetm.calls.return_in_memory (type, fntype))
    return 1;
    return 1;
  /* Types that are TREE_ADDRESSABLE must be constructed in memory,
  /* Types that are TREE_ADDRESSABLE must be constructed in memory,
     and thus can't be returned in registers.  */
     and thus can't be returned in registers.  */
  if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
  if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
    return 1;
    return 1;
  if (flag_pcc_struct_return && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type))
  if (flag_pcc_struct_return && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type))
    return 1;
    return 1;
  /* Make sure we have suitable call-clobbered regs to return
  /* Make sure we have suitable call-clobbered regs to return
     the value in; if not, we must return it in memory.  */
     the value in; if not, we must return it in memory.  */
  reg = hard_function_value (type, 0, fntype, 0);
  reg = hard_function_value (type, 0, fntype, 0);
 
 
  /* If we have something other than a REG (e.g. a PARALLEL), then assume
  /* If we have something other than a REG (e.g. a PARALLEL), then assume
     it is OK.  */
     it is OK.  */
  if (!REG_P (reg))
  if (!REG_P (reg))
    return 0;
    return 0;
 
 
  regno = REGNO (reg);
  regno = REGNO (reg);
  nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][TYPE_MODE (type)];
  nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][TYPE_MODE (type)];
  for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
  for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
    if (! call_used_regs[regno + i])
    if (! call_used_regs[regno + i])
      return 1;
      return 1;
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}


/* Return true if we should assign DECL a pseudo register; false if it
/* Return true if we should assign DECL a pseudo register; false if it
   should live on the local stack.  */
   should live on the local stack.  */
 
 
bool
bool
use_register_for_decl (tree decl)
use_register_for_decl (tree decl)
{
{
  /* Honor volatile.  */
  /* Honor volatile.  */
  if (TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (decl))
  if (TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (decl))
    return false;
    return false;
 
 
  /* Honor addressability.  */
  /* Honor addressability.  */
  if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (decl))
  if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (decl))
    return false;
    return false;
 
 
  /* Only register-like things go in registers.  */
  /* Only register-like things go in registers.  */
  if (DECL_MODE (decl) == BLKmode)
  if (DECL_MODE (decl) == BLKmode)
    return false;
    return false;
 
 
  /* If -ffloat-store specified, don't put explicit float variables
  /* If -ffloat-store specified, don't put explicit float variables
     into registers.  */
     into registers.  */
  /* ??? This should be checked after DECL_ARTIFICIAL, but tree-ssa
  /* ??? This should be checked after DECL_ARTIFICIAL, but tree-ssa
     propagates values across these stores, and it probably shouldn't.  */
     propagates values across these stores, and it probably shouldn't.  */
  if (flag_float_store && FLOAT_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
  if (flag_float_store && FLOAT_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
    return false;
    return false;
 
 
  /* If we're not interested in tracking debugging information for
  /* If we're not interested in tracking debugging information for
     this decl, then we can certainly put it in a register.  */
     this decl, then we can certainly put it in a register.  */
  if (DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
  if (DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
    return true;
    return true;
 
 
  return (optimize || DECL_REGISTER (decl));
  return (optimize || DECL_REGISTER (decl));
}
}
 
 
/* Return true if TYPE should be passed by invisible reference.  */
/* Return true if TYPE should be passed by invisible reference.  */
 
 
bool
bool
pass_by_reference (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *ca, enum machine_mode mode,
pass_by_reference (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *ca, enum machine_mode mode,
                   tree type, bool named_arg)
                   tree type, bool named_arg)
{
{
  if (type)
  if (type)
    {
    {
      /* If this type contains non-trivial constructors, then it is
      /* If this type contains non-trivial constructors, then it is
         forbidden for the middle-end to create any new copies.  */
         forbidden for the middle-end to create any new copies.  */
      if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
      if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
        return true;
        return true;
 
 
      /* GCC post 3.4 passes *all* variable sized types by reference.  */
      /* GCC post 3.4 passes *all* variable sized types by reference.  */
      if (!TYPE_SIZE (type) || TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) != INTEGER_CST)
      if (!TYPE_SIZE (type) || TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) != INTEGER_CST)
        return true;
        return true;
    }
    }
 
 
  return targetm.calls.pass_by_reference (ca, mode, type, named_arg);
  return targetm.calls.pass_by_reference (ca, mode, type, named_arg);
}
}
 
 
/* Return true if TYPE, which is passed by reference, should be callee
/* Return true if TYPE, which is passed by reference, should be callee
   copied instead of caller copied.  */
   copied instead of caller copied.  */
 
 
bool
bool
reference_callee_copied (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *ca, enum machine_mode mode,
reference_callee_copied (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *ca, enum machine_mode mode,
                         tree type, bool named_arg)
                         tree type, bool named_arg)
{
{
  if (type && TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
  if (type && TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
    return false;
    return false;
  return targetm.calls.callee_copies (ca, mode, type, named_arg);
  return targetm.calls.callee_copies (ca, mode, type, named_arg);
}
}
 
 
/* Structures to communicate between the subroutines of assign_parms.
/* Structures to communicate between the subroutines of assign_parms.
   The first holds data persistent across all parameters, the second
   The first holds data persistent across all parameters, the second
   is cleared out for each parameter.  */
   is cleared out for each parameter.  */
 
 
struct assign_parm_data_all
struct assign_parm_data_all
{
{
  CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far;
  CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far;
  struct args_size stack_args_size;
  struct args_size stack_args_size;
  tree function_result_decl;
  tree function_result_decl;
  tree orig_fnargs;
  tree orig_fnargs;
  rtx conversion_insns;
  rtx conversion_insns;
  HOST_WIDE_INT pretend_args_size;
  HOST_WIDE_INT pretend_args_size;
  HOST_WIDE_INT extra_pretend_bytes;
  HOST_WIDE_INT extra_pretend_bytes;
  int reg_parm_stack_space;
  int reg_parm_stack_space;
};
};
 
 
struct assign_parm_data_one
struct assign_parm_data_one
{
{
  tree nominal_type;
  tree nominal_type;
  tree passed_type;
  tree passed_type;
  rtx entry_parm;
  rtx entry_parm;
  rtx stack_parm;
  rtx stack_parm;
  enum machine_mode nominal_mode;
  enum machine_mode nominal_mode;
  enum machine_mode passed_mode;
  enum machine_mode passed_mode;
  enum machine_mode promoted_mode;
  enum machine_mode promoted_mode;
  struct locate_and_pad_arg_data locate;
  struct locate_and_pad_arg_data locate;
  int partial;
  int partial;
  BOOL_BITFIELD named_arg : 1;
  BOOL_BITFIELD named_arg : 1;
  BOOL_BITFIELD passed_pointer : 1;
  BOOL_BITFIELD passed_pointer : 1;
  BOOL_BITFIELD on_stack : 1;
  BOOL_BITFIELD on_stack : 1;
  BOOL_BITFIELD loaded_in_reg : 1;
  BOOL_BITFIELD loaded_in_reg : 1;
};
};
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Initialize ALL.  */
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Initialize ALL.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parms_initialize_all (struct assign_parm_data_all *all)
assign_parms_initialize_all (struct assign_parm_data_all *all)
{
{
  tree fntype;
  tree fntype;
 
 
  memset (all, 0, sizeof (*all));
  memset (all, 0, sizeof (*all));
 
 
  fntype = TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl);
  fntype = TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl);
 
 
#ifdef INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
#ifdef INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
  INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (all->args_so_far, fntype, NULL_RTX);
  INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (all->args_so_far, fntype, NULL_RTX);
#else
#else
  INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (all->args_so_far, fntype, NULL_RTX,
  INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (all->args_so_far, fntype, NULL_RTX,
                        current_function_decl, -1);
                        current_function_decl, -1);
#endif
#endif
 
 
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
  all->reg_parm_stack_space = REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (current_function_decl);
  all->reg_parm_stack_space = REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (current_function_decl);
#endif
#endif
}
}
 
 
/* If ARGS contains entries with complex types, split the entry into two
/* If ARGS contains entries with complex types, split the entry into two
   entries of the component type.  Return a new list of substitutions are
   entries of the component type.  Return a new list of substitutions are
   needed, else the old list.  */
   needed, else the old list.  */
 
 
static tree
static tree
split_complex_args (tree args)
split_complex_args (tree args)
{
{
  tree p;
  tree p;
 
 
  /* Before allocating memory, check for the common case of no complex.  */
  /* Before allocating memory, check for the common case of no complex.  */
  for (p = args; p; p = TREE_CHAIN (p))
  for (p = args; p; p = TREE_CHAIN (p))
    {
    {
      tree type = TREE_TYPE (p);
      tree type = TREE_TYPE (p);
      if (TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE
      if (TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE
          && targetm.calls.split_complex_arg (type))
          && targetm.calls.split_complex_arg (type))
        goto found;
        goto found;
    }
    }
  return args;
  return args;
 
 
 found:
 found:
  args = copy_list (args);
  args = copy_list (args);
 
 
  for (p = args; p; p = TREE_CHAIN (p))
  for (p = args; p; p = TREE_CHAIN (p))
    {
    {
      tree type = TREE_TYPE (p);
      tree type = TREE_TYPE (p);
      if (TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE
      if (TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE
          && targetm.calls.split_complex_arg (type))
          && targetm.calls.split_complex_arg (type))
        {
        {
          tree decl;
          tree decl;
          tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
          tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
          bool addressable = TREE_ADDRESSABLE (p);
          bool addressable = TREE_ADDRESSABLE (p);
 
 
          /* Rewrite the PARM_DECL's type with its component.  */
          /* Rewrite the PARM_DECL's type with its component.  */
          TREE_TYPE (p) = subtype;
          TREE_TYPE (p) = subtype;
          DECL_ARG_TYPE (p) = TREE_TYPE (DECL_ARG_TYPE (p));
          DECL_ARG_TYPE (p) = TREE_TYPE (DECL_ARG_TYPE (p));
          DECL_MODE (p) = VOIDmode;
          DECL_MODE (p) = VOIDmode;
          DECL_SIZE (p) = NULL;
          DECL_SIZE (p) = NULL;
          DECL_SIZE_UNIT (p) = NULL;
          DECL_SIZE_UNIT (p) = NULL;
          /* If this arg must go in memory, put it in a pseudo here.
          /* If this arg must go in memory, put it in a pseudo here.
             We can't allow it to go in memory as per normal parms,
             We can't allow it to go in memory as per normal parms,
             because the usual place might not have the imag part
             because the usual place might not have the imag part
             adjacent to the real part.  */
             adjacent to the real part.  */
          DECL_ARTIFICIAL (p) = addressable;
          DECL_ARTIFICIAL (p) = addressable;
          DECL_IGNORED_P (p) = addressable;
          DECL_IGNORED_P (p) = addressable;
          TREE_ADDRESSABLE (p) = 0;
          TREE_ADDRESSABLE (p) = 0;
          layout_decl (p, 0);
          layout_decl (p, 0);
 
 
          /* Build a second synthetic decl.  */
          /* Build a second synthetic decl.  */
          decl = build_decl (PARM_DECL, NULL_TREE, subtype);
          decl = build_decl (PARM_DECL, NULL_TREE, subtype);
          DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) = DECL_ARG_TYPE (p);
          DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) = DECL_ARG_TYPE (p);
          DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = addressable;
          DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = addressable;
          DECL_IGNORED_P (decl) = addressable;
          DECL_IGNORED_P (decl) = addressable;
          layout_decl (decl, 0);
          layout_decl (decl, 0);
 
 
          /* Splice it in; skip the new decl.  */
          /* Splice it in; skip the new decl.  */
          TREE_CHAIN (decl) = TREE_CHAIN (p);
          TREE_CHAIN (decl) = TREE_CHAIN (p);
          TREE_CHAIN (p) = decl;
          TREE_CHAIN (p) = decl;
          p = decl;
          p = decl;
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  return args;
  return args;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Adjust the parameter list to incorporate
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Adjust the parameter list to incorporate
   the hidden struct return argument, and (abi willing) complex args.
   the hidden struct return argument, and (abi willing) complex args.
   Return the new parameter list.  */
   Return the new parameter list.  */
 
 
static tree
static tree
assign_parms_augmented_arg_list (struct assign_parm_data_all *all)
assign_parms_augmented_arg_list (struct assign_parm_data_all *all)
{
{
  tree fndecl = current_function_decl;
  tree fndecl = current_function_decl;
  tree fntype = TREE_TYPE (fndecl);
  tree fntype = TREE_TYPE (fndecl);
  tree fnargs = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
  tree fnargs = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
 
 
  /* If struct value address is treated as the first argument, make it so.  */
  /* If struct value address is treated as the first argument, make it so.  */
  if (aggregate_value_p (DECL_RESULT (fndecl), fndecl)
  if (aggregate_value_p (DECL_RESULT (fndecl), fndecl)
      && ! current_function_returns_pcc_struct
      && ! current_function_returns_pcc_struct
      && targetm.calls.struct_value_rtx (TREE_TYPE (fndecl), 1) == 0)
      && targetm.calls.struct_value_rtx (TREE_TYPE (fndecl), 1) == 0)
    {
    {
      tree type = build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fntype));
      tree type = build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fntype));
      tree decl;
      tree decl;
 
 
      decl = build_decl (PARM_DECL, NULL_TREE, type);
      decl = build_decl (PARM_DECL, NULL_TREE, type);
      DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) = type;
      DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) = type;
      DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = 1;
      DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = 1;
      DECL_IGNORED_P (decl) = 1;
      DECL_IGNORED_P (decl) = 1;
 
 
      TREE_CHAIN (decl) = fnargs;
      TREE_CHAIN (decl) = fnargs;
      fnargs = decl;
      fnargs = decl;
      all->function_result_decl = decl;
      all->function_result_decl = decl;
    }
    }
 
 
  all->orig_fnargs = fnargs;
  all->orig_fnargs = fnargs;
 
 
  /* If the target wants to split complex arguments into scalars, do so.  */
  /* If the target wants to split complex arguments into scalars, do so.  */
  if (targetm.calls.split_complex_arg)
  if (targetm.calls.split_complex_arg)
    fnargs = split_complex_args (fnargs);
    fnargs = split_complex_args (fnargs);
 
 
  return fnargs;
  return fnargs;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Examine PARM and pull out type and mode
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Examine PARM and pull out type and mode
   data for the parameter.  Incorporate ABI specifics such as pass-by-
   data for the parameter.  Incorporate ABI specifics such as pass-by-
   reference and type promotion.  */
   reference and type promotion.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parm_find_data_types (struct assign_parm_data_all *all, tree parm,
assign_parm_find_data_types (struct assign_parm_data_all *all, tree parm,
                             struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
                             struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  tree nominal_type, passed_type;
  tree nominal_type, passed_type;
  enum machine_mode nominal_mode, passed_mode, promoted_mode;
  enum machine_mode nominal_mode, passed_mode, promoted_mode;
 
 
  memset (data, 0, sizeof (*data));
  memset (data, 0, sizeof (*data));
 
 
  /* NAMED_ARG is a mis-nomer.  We really mean 'non-varadic'. */
  /* NAMED_ARG is a mis-nomer.  We really mean 'non-varadic'. */
  if (!current_function_stdarg)
  if (!current_function_stdarg)
    data->named_arg = 1;  /* No varadic parms.  */
    data->named_arg = 1;  /* No varadic parms.  */
  else if (TREE_CHAIN (parm))
  else if (TREE_CHAIN (parm))
    data->named_arg = 1;  /* Not the last non-varadic parm. */
    data->named_arg = 1;  /* Not the last non-varadic parm. */
  else if (targetm.calls.strict_argument_naming (&all->args_so_far))
  else if (targetm.calls.strict_argument_naming (&all->args_so_far))
    data->named_arg = 1;  /* Only varadic ones are unnamed.  */
    data->named_arg = 1;  /* Only varadic ones are unnamed.  */
  else
  else
    data->named_arg = 0;  /* Treat as varadic.  */
    data->named_arg = 0;  /* Treat as varadic.  */
 
 
  nominal_type = TREE_TYPE (parm);
  nominal_type = TREE_TYPE (parm);
  passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (parm);
  passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (parm);
 
 
  /* Look out for errors propagating this far.  Also, if the parameter's
  /* Look out for errors propagating this far.  Also, if the parameter's
     type is void then its value doesn't matter.  */
     type is void then its value doesn't matter.  */
  if (TREE_TYPE (parm) == error_mark_node
  if (TREE_TYPE (parm) == error_mark_node
      /* This can happen after weird syntax errors
      /* This can happen after weird syntax errors
         or if an enum type is defined among the parms.  */
         or if an enum type is defined among the parms.  */
      || TREE_CODE (parm) != PARM_DECL
      || TREE_CODE (parm) != PARM_DECL
      || passed_type == NULL
      || passed_type == NULL
      || VOID_TYPE_P (nominal_type))
      || VOID_TYPE_P (nominal_type))
    {
    {
      nominal_type = passed_type = void_type_node;
      nominal_type = passed_type = void_type_node;
      nominal_mode = passed_mode = promoted_mode = VOIDmode;
      nominal_mode = passed_mode = promoted_mode = VOIDmode;
      goto egress;
      goto egress;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Find mode of arg as it is passed, and mode of arg as it should be
  /* Find mode of arg as it is passed, and mode of arg as it should be
     during execution of this function.  */
     during execution of this function.  */
  passed_mode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
  passed_mode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
  nominal_mode = TYPE_MODE (nominal_type);
  nominal_mode = TYPE_MODE (nominal_type);
 
 
  /* If the parm is to be passed as a transparent union, use the type of
  /* If the parm is to be passed as a transparent union, use the type of
     the first field for the tests below.  We have already verified that
     the first field for the tests below.  We have already verified that
     the modes are the same.  */
     the modes are the same.  */
  if (TREE_CODE (passed_type) == UNION_TYPE
  if (TREE_CODE (passed_type) == UNION_TYPE
      && TYPE_TRANSPARENT_UNION (passed_type))
      && TYPE_TRANSPARENT_UNION (passed_type))
    passed_type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (passed_type));
    passed_type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (passed_type));
 
 
  /* See if this arg was passed by invisible reference.  */
  /* See if this arg was passed by invisible reference.  */
  if (pass_by_reference (&all->args_so_far, passed_mode,
  if (pass_by_reference (&all->args_so_far, passed_mode,
                         passed_type, data->named_arg))
                         passed_type, data->named_arg))
    {
    {
      passed_type = nominal_type = build_pointer_type (passed_type);
      passed_type = nominal_type = build_pointer_type (passed_type);
      data->passed_pointer = true;
      data->passed_pointer = true;
      passed_mode = nominal_mode = Pmode;
      passed_mode = nominal_mode = Pmode;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Find mode as it is passed by the ABI.  */
  /* Find mode as it is passed by the ABI.  */
  promoted_mode = passed_mode;
  promoted_mode = passed_mode;
  if (targetm.calls.promote_function_args (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)))
  if (targetm.calls.promote_function_args (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)))
    {
    {
      int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (passed_type);
      int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (passed_type);
      promoted_mode = promote_mode (passed_type, promoted_mode,
      promoted_mode = promote_mode (passed_type, promoted_mode,
                                    &unsignedp, 1);
                                    &unsignedp, 1);
    }
    }
 
 
 egress:
 egress:
  data->nominal_type = nominal_type;
  data->nominal_type = nominal_type;
  data->passed_type = passed_type;
  data->passed_type = passed_type;
  data->nominal_mode = nominal_mode;
  data->nominal_mode = nominal_mode;
  data->passed_mode = passed_mode;
  data->passed_mode = passed_mode;
  data->promoted_mode = promoted_mode;
  data->promoted_mode = promoted_mode;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Invoke setup_incoming_varargs.  */
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Invoke setup_incoming_varargs.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parms_setup_varargs (struct assign_parm_data_all *all,
assign_parms_setup_varargs (struct assign_parm_data_all *all,
                            struct assign_parm_data_one *data, bool no_rtl)
                            struct assign_parm_data_one *data, bool no_rtl)
{
{
  int varargs_pretend_bytes = 0;
  int varargs_pretend_bytes = 0;
 
 
  targetm.calls.setup_incoming_varargs (&all->args_so_far,
  targetm.calls.setup_incoming_varargs (&all->args_so_far,
                                        data->promoted_mode,
                                        data->promoted_mode,
                                        data->passed_type,
                                        data->passed_type,
                                        &varargs_pretend_bytes, no_rtl);
                                        &varargs_pretend_bytes, no_rtl);
 
 
  /* If the back-end has requested extra stack space, record how much is
  /* If the back-end has requested extra stack space, record how much is
     needed.  Do not change pretend_args_size otherwise since it may be
     needed.  Do not change pretend_args_size otherwise since it may be
     nonzero from an earlier partial argument.  */
     nonzero from an earlier partial argument.  */
  if (varargs_pretend_bytes > 0)
  if (varargs_pretend_bytes > 0)
    all->pretend_args_size = varargs_pretend_bytes;
    all->pretend_args_size = varargs_pretend_bytes;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Set DATA->ENTRY_PARM corresponding to
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Set DATA->ENTRY_PARM corresponding to
   the incoming location of the current parameter.  */
   the incoming location of the current parameter.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parm_find_entry_rtl (struct assign_parm_data_all *all,
assign_parm_find_entry_rtl (struct assign_parm_data_all *all,
                            struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
                            struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  HOST_WIDE_INT pretend_bytes = 0;
  HOST_WIDE_INT pretend_bytes = 0;
  rtx entry_parm;
  rtx entry_parm;
  bool in_regs;
  bool in_regs;
 
 
  if (data->promoted_mode == VOIDmode)
  if (data->promoted_mode == VOIDmode)
    {
    {
      data->entry_parm = data->stack_parm = const0_rtx;
      data->entry_parm = data->stack_parm = const0_rtx;
      return;
      return;
    }
    }
 
 
#ifdef FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
#ifdef FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
  entry_parm = FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (all->args_so_far, data->promoted_mode,
  entry_parm = FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (all->args_so_far, data->promoted_mode,
                                      data->passed_type, data->named_arg);
                                      data->passed_type, data->named_arg);
#else
#else
  entry_parm = FUNCTION_ARG (all->args_so_far, data->promoted_mode,
  entry_parm = FUNCTION_ARG (all->args_so_far, data->promoted_mode,
                             data->passed_type, data->named_arg);
                             data->passed_type, data->named_arg);
#endif
#endif
 
 
  if (entry_parm == 0)
  if (entry_parm == 0)
    data->promoted_mode = data->passed_mode;
    data->promoted_mode = data->passed_mode;
 
 
  /* Determine parm's home in the stack, in case it arrives in the stack
  /* Determine parm's home in the stack, in case it arrives in the stack
     or we should pretend it did.  Compute the stack position and rtx where
     or we should pretend it did.  Compute the stack position and rtx where
     the argument arrives and its size.
     the argument arrives and its size.
 
 
     There is one complexity here:  If this was a parameter that would
     There is one complexity here:  If this was a parameter that would
     have been passed in registers, but wasn't only because it is
     have been passed in registers, but wasn't only because it is
     __builtin_va_alist, we want locate_and_pad_parm to treat it as if
     __builtin_va_alist, we want locate_and_pad_parm to treat it as if
     it came in a register so that REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE isn't skipped.
     it came in a register so that REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE isn't skipped.
     In this case, we call FUNCTION_ARG with NAMED set to 1 instead of 0
     In this case, we call FUNCTION_ARG with NAMED set to 1 instead of 0
     as it was the previous time.  */
     as it was the previous time.  */
  in_regs = entry_parm != 0;
  in_regs = entry_parm != 0;
#ifdef STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
#ifdef STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
  in_regs = true;
  in_regs = true;
#endif
#endif
  if (!in_regs && !data->named_arg)
  if (!in_regs && !data->named_arg)
    {
    {
      if (targetm.calls.pretend_outgoing_varargs_named (&all->args_so_far))
      if (targetm.calls.pretend_outgoing_varargs_named (&all->args_so_far))
        {
        {
          rtx tem;
          rtx tem;
#ifdef FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
#ifdef FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
          tem = FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (all->args_so_far, data->promoted_mode,
          tem = FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (all->args_so_far, data->promoted_mode,
                                       data->passed_type, true);
                                       data->passed_type, true);
#else
#else
          tem = FUNCTION_ARG (all->args_so_far, data->promoted_mode,
          tem = FUNCTION_ARG (all->args_so_far, data->promoted_mode,
                              data->passed_type, true);
                              data->passed_type, true);
#endif
#endif
          in_regs = tem != NULL;
          in_regs = tem != NULL;
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  /* If this parameter was passed both in registers and in the stack, use
  /* If this parameter was passed both in registers and in the stack, use
     the copy on the stack.  */
     the copy on the stack.  */
  if (targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack (data->promoted_mode,
  if (targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack (data->promoted_mode,
                                        data->passed_type))
                                        data->passed_type))
    entry_parm = 0;
    entry_parm = 0;
 
 
  if (entry_parm)
  if (entry_parm)
    {
    {
      int partial;
      int partial;
 
 
      partial = targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (&all->args_so_far,
      partial = targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (&all->args_so_far,
                                                 data->promoted_mode,
                                                 data->promoted_mode,
                                                 data->passed_type,
                                                 data->passed_type,
                                                 data->named_arg);
                                                 data->named_arg);
      data->partial = partial;
      data->partial = partial;
 
 
      /* The caller might already have allocated stack space for the
      /* The caller might already have allocated stack space for the
         register parameters.  */
         register parameters.  */
      if (partial != 0 && all->reg_parm_stack_space == 0)
      if (partial != 0 && all->reg_parm_stack_space == 0)
        {
        {
          /* Part of this argument is passed in registers and part
          /* Part of this argument is passed in registers and part
             is passed on the stack.  Ask the prologue code to extend
             is passed on the stack.  Ask the prologue code to extend
             the stack part so that we can recreate the full value.
             the stack part so that we can recreate the full value.
 
 
             PRETEND_BYTES is the size of the registers we need to store.
             PRETEND_BYTES is the size of the registers we need to store.
             CURRENT_FUNCTION_PRETEND_ARGS_SIZE is the amount of extra
             CURRENT_FUNCTION_PRETEND_ARGS_SIZE is the amount of extra
             stack space that the prologue should allocate.
             stack space that the prologue should allocate.
 
 
             Internally, gcc assumes that the argument pointer is aligned
             Internally, gcc assumes that the argument pointer is aligned
             to STACK_BOUNDARY bits.  This is used both for alignment
             to STACK_BOUNDARY bits.  This is used both for alignment
             optimizations (see init_emit) and to locate arguments that are
             optimizations (see init_emit) and to locate arguments that are
             aligned to more than PARM_BOUNDARY bits.  We must preserve this
             aligned to more than PARM_BOUNDARY bits.  We must preserve this
             invariant by rounding CURRENT_FUNCTION_PRETEND_ARGS_SIZE up to
             invariant by rounding CURRENT_FUNCTION_PRETEND_ARGS_SIZE up to
             a stack boundary.  */
             a stack boundary.  */
 
 
          /* We assume at most one partial arg, and it must be the first
          /* We assume at most one partial arg, and it must be the first
             argument on the stack.  */
             argument on the stack.  */
          gcc_assert (!all->extra_pretend_bytes && !all->pretend_args_size);
          gcc_assert (!all->extra_pretend_bytes && !all->pretend_args_size);
 
 
          pretend_bytes = partial;
          pretend_bytes = partial;
          all->pretend_args_size = CEIL_ROUND (pretend_bytes, STACK_BYTES);
          all->pretend_args_size = CEIL_ROUND (pretend_bytes, STACK_BYTES);
 
 
          /* We want to align relative to the actual stack pointer, so
          /* We want to align relative to the actual stack pointer, so
             don't include this in the stack size until later.  */
             don't include this in the stack size until later.  */
          all->extra_pretend_bytes = all->pretend_args_size;
          all->extra_pretend_bytes = all->pretend_args_size;
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  locate_and_pad_parm (data->promoted_mode, data->passed_type, in_regs,
  locate_and_pad_parm (data->promoted_mode, data->passed_type, in_regs,
                       entry_parm ? data->partial : 0, current_function_decl,
                       entry_parm ? data->partial : 0, current_function_decl,
                       &all->stack_args_size, &data->locate);
                       &all->stack_args_size, &data->locate);
 
 
  /* Adjust offsets to include the pretend args.  */
  /* Adjust offsets to include the pretend args.  */
  pretend_bytes = all->extra_pretend_bytes - pretend_bytes;
  pretend_bytes = all->extra_pretend_bytes - pretend_bytes;
  data->locate.slot_offset.constant += pretend_bytes;
  data->locate.slot_offset.constant += pretend_bytes;
  data->locate.offset.constant += pretend_bytes;
  data->locate.offset.constant += pretend_bytes;
 
 
  data->entry_parm = entry_parm;
  data->entry_parm = entry_parm;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  If there is actually space on the stack
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  If there is actually space on the stack
   for this parm, count it in stack_args_size and return true.  */
   for this parm, count it in stack_args_size and return true.  */
 
 
static bool
static bool
assign_parm_is_stack_parm (struct assign_parm_data_all *all,
assign_parm_is_stack_parm (struct assign_parm_data_all *all,
                           struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
                           struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  /* Trivially true if we've no incoming register.  */
  /* Trivially true if we've no incoming register.  */
  if (data->entry_parm == NULL)
  if (data->entry_parm == NULL)
    ;
    ;
  /* Also true if we're partially in registers and partially not,
  /* Also true if we're partially in registers and partially not,
     since we've arranged to drop the entire argument on the stack.  */
     since we've arranged to drop the entire argument on the stack.  */
  else if (data->partial != 0)
  else if (data->partial != 0)
    ;
    ;
  /* Also true if the target says that it's passed in both registers
  /* Also true if the target says that it's passed in both registers
     and on the stack.  */
     and on the stack.  */
  else if (GET_CODE (data->entry_parm) == PARALLEL
  else if (GET_CODE (data->entry_parm) == PARALLEL
           && XEXP (XVECEXP (data->entry_parm, 0, 0), 0) == NULL_RTX)
           && XEXP (XVECEXP (data->entry_parm, 0, 0), 0) == NULL_RTX)
    ;
    ;
  /* Also true if the target says that there's stack allocated for
  /* Also true if the target says that there's stack allocated for
     all register parameters.  */
     all register parameters.  */
  else if (all->reg_parm_stack_space > 0)
  else if (all->reg_parm_stack_space > 0)
    ;
    ;
  /* Otherwise, no, this parameter has no ABI defined stack slot.  */
  /* Otherwise, no, this parameter has no ABI defined stack slot.  */
  else
  else
    return false;
    return false;
 
 
  all->stack_args_size.constant += data->locate.size.constant;
  all->stack_args_size.constant += data->locate.size.constant;
  if (data->locate.size.var)
  if (data->locate.size.var)
    ADD_PARM_SIZE (all->stack_args_size, data->locate.size.var);
    ADD_PARM_SIZE (all->stack_args_size, data->locate.size.var);
 
 
  return true;
  return true;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Given that this parameter is allocated
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Given that this parameter is allocated
   stack space by the ABI, find it.  */
   stack space by the ABI, find it.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parm_find_stack_rtl (tree parm, struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
assign_parm_find_stack_rtl (tree parm, struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  rtx offset_rtx, stack_parm;
  rtx offset_rtx, stack_parm;
  unsigned int align, boundary;
  unsigned int align, boundary;
 
 
  /* If we're passing this arg using a reg, make its stack home the
  /* If we're passing this arg using a reg, make its stack home the
     aligned stack slot.  */
     aligned stack slot.  */
  if (data->entry_parm)
  if (data->entry_parm)
    offset_rtx = ARGS_SIZE_RTX (data->locate.slot_offset);
    offset_rtx = ARGS_SIZE_RTX (data->locate.slot_offset);
  else
  else
    offset_rtx = ARGS_SIZE_RTX (data->locate.offset);
    offset_rtx = ARGS_SIZE_RTX (data->locate.offset);
 
 
  stack_parm = current_function_internal_arg_pointer;
  stack_parm = current_function_internal_arg_pointer;
  if (offset_rtx != const0_rtx)
  if (offset_rtx != const0_rtx)
    stack_parm = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_parm, offset_rtx);
    stack_parm = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_parm, offset_rtx);
  stack_parm = gen_rtx_MEM (data->promoted_mode, stack_parm);
  stack_parm = gen_rtx_MEM (data->promoted_mode, stack_parm);
 
 
  set_mem_attributes (stack_parm, parm, 1);
  set_mem_attributes (stack_parm, parm, 1);
 
 
  boundary = data->locate.boundary;
  boundary = data->locate.boundary;
  align = BITS_PER_UNIT;
  align = BITS_PER_UNIT;
 
 
  /* If we're padding upward, we know that the alignment of the slot
  /* If we're padding upward, we know that the alignment of the slot
     is FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY.  If we're using slot_offset, we're
     is FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY.  If we're using slot_offset, we're
     intentionally forcing upward padding.  Otherwise we have to come
     intentionally forcing upward padding.  Otherwise we have to come
     up with a guess at the alignment based on OFFSET_RTX.  */
     up with a guess at the alignment based on OFFSET_RTX.  */
  if (data->locate.where_pad != downward || data->entry_parm)
  if (data->locate.where_pad != downward || data->entry_parm)
    align = boundary;
    align = boundary;
  else if (GET_CODE (offset_rtx) == CONST_INT)
  else if (GET_CODE (offset_rtx) == CONST_INT)
    {
    {
      align = INTVAL (offset_rtx) * BITS_PER_UNIT | boundary;
      align = INTVAL (offset_rtx) * BITS_PER_UNIT | boundary;
      align = align & -align;
      align = align & -align;
    }
    }
  set_mem_align (stack_parm, align);
  set_mem_align (stack_parm, align);
 
 
  if (data->entry_parm)
  if (data->entry_parm)
    set_reg_attrs_for_parm (data->entry_parm, stack_parm);
    set_reg_attrs_for_parm (data->entry_parm, stack_parm);
 
 
  data->stack_parm = stack_parm;
  data->stack_parm = stack_parm;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Adjust DATA->ENTRY_RTL such that it's
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Adjust DATA->ENTRY_RTL such that it's
   always valid and contiguous.  */
   always valid and contiguous.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parm_adjust_entry_rtl (struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
assign_parm_adjust_entry_rtl (struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  rtx entry_parm = data->entry_parm;
  rtx entry_parm = data->entry_parm;
  rtx stack_parm = data->stack_parm;
  rtx stack_parm = data->stack_parm;
 
 
  /* If this parm was passed part in regs and part in memory, pretend it
  /* If this parm was passed part in regs and part in memory, pretend it
     arrived entirely in memory by pushing the register-part onto the stack.
     arrived entirely in memory by pushing the register-part onto the stack.
     In the special case of a DImode or DFmode that is split, we could put
     In the special case of a DImode or DFmode that is split, we could put
     it together in a pseudoreg directly, but for now that's not worth
     it together in a pseudoreg directly, but for now that's not worth
     bothering with.  */
     bothering with.  */
  if (data->partial != 0)
  if (data->partial != 0)
    {
    {
      /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
      /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
         locations.  The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this.  */
         locations.  The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this.  */
      if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
      if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
        emit_group_store (validize_mem (stack_parm), entry_parm,
        emit_group_store (validize_mem (stack_parm), entry_parm,
                          data->passed_type,
                          data->passed_type,
                          int_size_in_bytes (data->passed_type));
                          int_size_in_bytes (data->passed_type));
      else
      else
        {
        {
          gcc_assert (data->partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
          gcc_assert (data->partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
          move_block_from_reg (REGNO (entry_parm), validize_mem (stack_parm),
          move_block_from_reg (REGNO (entry_parm), validize_mem (stack_parm),
                               data->partial / UNITS_PER_WORD);
                               data->partial / UNITS_PER_WORD);
        }
        }
 
 
      entry_parm = stack_parm;
      entry_parm = stack_parm;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* If we didn't decide this parm came in a register, by default it came
  /* If we didn't decide this parm came in a register, by default it came
     on the stack.  */
     on the stack.  */
  else if (entry_parm == NULL)
  else if (entry_parm == NULL)
    entry_parm = stack_parm;
    entry_parm = stack_parm;
 
 
  /* When an argument is passed in multiple locations, we can't make use
  /* When an argument is passed in multiple locations, we can't make use
     of this information, but we can save some copying if the whole argument
     of this information, but we can save some copying if the whole argument
     is passed in a single register.  */
     is passed in a single register.  */
  else if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL
  else if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL
           && data->nominal_mode != BLKmode
           && data->nominal_mode != BLKmode
           && data->passed_mode != BLKmode)
           && data->passed_mode != BLKmode)
    {
    {
      size_t i, len = XVECLEN (entry_parm, 0);
      size_t i, len = XVECLEN (entry_parm, 0);
 
 
      for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
      for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
        if (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0) != NULL_RTX
        if (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0) != NULL_RTX
            && REG_P (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0))
            && REG_P (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0))
            && (GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0))
            && (GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0))
                == data->passed_mode)
                == data->passed_mode)
            && INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 1)) == 0)
            && INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 1)) == 0)
          {
          {
            entry_parm = XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0);
            entry_parm = XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0);
            break;
            break;
          }
          }
    }
    }
 
 
  data->entry_parm = entry_parm;
  data->entry_parm = entry_parm;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Adjust DATA->STACK_RTL such that it's
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Adjust DATA->STACK_RTL such that it's
   always valid and properly aligned.  */
   always valid and properly aligned.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parm_adjust_stack_rtl (struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
assign_parm_adjust_stack_rtl (struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  rtx stack_parm = data->stack_parm;
  rtx stack_parm = data->stack_parm;
 
 
  /* If we can't trust the parm stack slot to be aligned enough for its
  /* If we can't trust the parm stack slot to be aligned enough for its
     ultimate type, don't use that slot after entry.  We'll make another
     ultimate type, don't use that slot after entry.  We'll make another
     stack slot, if we need one.  */
     stack slot, if we need one.  */
  if (stack_parm
  if (stack_parm
      && ((STRICT_ALIGNMENT
      && ((STRICT_ALIGNMENT
           && GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (data->nominal_mode) > MEM_ALIGN (stack_parm))
           && GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (data->nominal_mode) > MEM_ALIGN (stack_parm))
          || (data->nominal_type
          || (data->nominal_type
              && TYPE_ALIGN (data->nominal_type) > MEM_ALIGN (stack_parm)
              && TYPE_ALIGN (data->nominal_type) > MEM_ALIGN (stack_parm)
              && MEM_ALIGN (stack_parm) < PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY)))
              && MEM_ALIGN (stack_parm) < PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY)))
    stack_parm = NULL;
    stack_parm = NULL;
 
 
  /* If parm was passed in memory, and we need to convert it on entry,
  /* If parm was passed in memory, and we need to convert it on entry,
     don't store it back in that same slot.  */
     don't store it back in that same slot.  */
  else if (data->entry_parm == stack_parm
  else if (data->entry_parm == stack_parm
           && data->nominal_mode != BLKmode
           && data->nominal_mode != BLKmode
           && data->nominal_mode != data->passed_mode)
           && data->nominal_mode != data->passed_mode)
    stack_parm = NULL;
    stack_parm = NULL;
 
 
  /* If stack protection is in effect for this function, don't leave any
  /* If stack protection is in effect for this function, don't leave any
     pointers in their passed stack slots.  */
     pointers in their passed stack slots.  */
  else if (cfun->stack_protect_guard
  else if (cfun->stack_protect_guard
           && (flag_stack_protect == 2
           && (flag_stack_protect == 2
               || data->passed_pointer
               || data->passed_pointer
               || POINTER_TYPE_P (data->nominal_type)))
               || POINTER_TYPE_P (data->nominal_type)))
    stack_parm = NULL;
    stack_parm = NULL;
 
 
  data->stack_parm = stack_parm;
  data->stack_parm = stack_parm;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Return true if the current parameter
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Return true if the current parameter
   should be stored as a BLKmode in the current frame.  */
   should be stored as a BLKmode in the current frame.  */
 
 
static bool
static bool
assign_parm_setup_block_p (struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
assign_parm_setup_block_p (struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  if (data->nominal_mode == BLKmode)
  if (data->nominal_mode == BLKmode)
    return true;
    return true;
  if (GET_CODE (data->entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
  if (GET_CODE (data->entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
    return true;
    return true;
 
 
#ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
#ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
  /* Only assign_parm_setup_block knows how to deal with register arguments
  /* Only assign_parm_setup_block knows how to deal with register arguments
     that are padded at the least significant end.  */
     that are padded at the least significant end.  */
  if (REG_P (data->entry_parm)
  if (REG_P (data->entry_parm)
      && GET_MODE_SIZE (data->promoted_mode) < UNITS_PER_WORD
      && GET_MODE_SIZE (data->promoted_mode) < UNITS_PER_WORD
      && (BLOCK_REG_PADDING (data->passed_mode, data->passed_type, 1)
      && (BLOCK_REG_PADDING (data->passed_mode, data->passed_type, 1)
          == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)))
          == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)))
    return true;
    return true;
#endif
#endif
 
 
  return false;
  return false;
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Arrange for the parameter to be
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Arrange for the parameter to be
   present and valid in DATA->STACK_RTL.  */
   present and valid in DATA->STACK_RTL.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parm_setup_block (struct assign_parm_data_all *all,
assign_parm_setup_block (struct assign_parm_data_all *all,
                         tree parm, struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
                         tree parm, struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  rtx entry_parm = data->entry_parm;
  rtx entry_parm = data->entry_parm;
  rtx stack_parm = data->stack_parm;
  rtx stack_parm = data->stack_parm;
  HOST_WIDE_INT size;
  HOST_WIDE_INT size;
  HOST_WIDE_INT size_stored;
  HOST_WIDE_INT size_stored;
  rtx orig_entry_parm = entry_parm;
  rtx orig_entry_parm = entry_parm;
 
 
  if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
  if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
    entry_parm = emit_group_move_into_temps (entry_parm);
    entry_parm = emit_group_move_into_temps (entry_parm);
 
 
  /* If we've a non-block object that's nevertheless passed in parts,
  /* If we've a non-block object that's nevertheless passed in parts,
     reconstitute it in register operations rather than on the stack.  */
     reconstitute it in register operations rather than on the stack.  */
  if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL
  if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL
      && data->nominal_mode != BLKmode)
      && data->nominal_mode != BLKmode)
    {
    {
      rtx elt0 = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig_entry_parm, 0, 0), 0);
      rtx elt0 = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig_entry_parm, 0, 0), 0);
 
 
      if ((XVECLEN (entry_parm, 0) > 1
      if ((XVECLEN (entry_parm, 0) > 1
           || hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (elt0)][GET_MODE (elt0)] > 1)
           || hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (elt0)][GET_MODE (elt0)] > 1)
          && use_register_for_decl (parm))
          && use_register_for_decl (parm))
        {
        {
          rtx parmreg = gen_reg_rtx (data->nominal_mode);
          rtx parmreg = gen_reg_rtx (data->nominal_mode);
 
 
          push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
          push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
 
 
          /* For values returned in multiple registers, handle possible
          /* For values returned in multiple registers, handle possible
             incompatible calls to emit_group_store.
             incompatible calls to emit_group_store.
 
 
             For example, the following would be invalid, and would have to
             For example, the following would be invalid, and would have to
             be fixed by the conditional below:
             be fixed by the conditional below:
 
 
             emit_group_store ((reg:SF), (parallel:DF))
             emit_group_store ((reg:SF), (parallel:DF))
             emit_group_store ((reg:SI), (parallel:DI))
             emit_group_store ((reg:SI), (parallel:DI))
 
 
             An example of this are doubles in e500 v2:
             An example of this are doubles in e500 v2:
             (parallel:DF (expr_list (reg:SI) (const_int 0))
             (parallel:DF (expr_list (reg:SI) (const_int 0))
             (expr_list (reg:SI) (const_int 4))).  */
             (expr_list (reg:SI) (const_int 4))).  */
          if (data->nominal_mode != data->passed_mode)
          if (data->nominal_mode != data->passed_mode)
            {
            {
              rtx t = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (entry_parm));
              rtx t = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (entry_parm));
              emit_group_store (t, entry_parm, NULL_TREE,
              emit_group_store (t, entry_parm, NULL_TREE,
                                GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (entry_parm)));
                                GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (entry_parm)));
              convert_move (parmreg, t, 0);
              convert_move (parmreg, t, 0);
            }
            }
          else
          else
            emit_group_store (parmreg, entry_parm, data->nominal_type,
            emit_group_store (parmreg, entry_parm, data->nominal_type,
                              int_size_in_bytes (data->nominal_type));
                              int_size_in_bytes (data->nominal_type));
 
 
          all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
          all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
          end_sequence ();
          end_sequence ();
 
 
          SET_DECL_RTL (parm, parmreg);
          SET_DECL_RTL (parm, parmreg);
          return;
          return;
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  size = int_size_in_bytes (data->passed_type);
  size = int_size_in_bytes (data->passed_type);
  size_stored = CEIL_ROUND (size, UNITS_PER_WORD);
  size_stored = CEIL_ROUND (size, UNITS_PER_WORD);
  if (stack_parm == 0)
  if (stack_parm == 0)
    {
    {
      DECL_ALIGN (parm) = MAX (DECL_ALIGN (parm), BITS_PER_WORD);
      DECL_ALIGN (parm) = MAX (DECL_ALIGN (parm), BITS_PER_WORD);
      stack_parm = assign_stack_local (BLKmode, size_stored,
      stack_parm = assign_stack_local (BLKmode, size_stored,
                                       DECL_ALIGN (parm));
                                       DECL_ALIGN (parm));
      if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (entry_parm)) == size)
      if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (entry_parm)) == size)
        PUT_MODE (stack_parm, GET_MODE (entry_parm));
        PUT_MODE (stack_parm, GET_MODE (entry_parm));
      set_mem_attributes (stack_parm, parm, 1);
      set_mem_attributes (stack_parm, parm, 1);
    }
    }
 
 
  /* If a BLKmode arrives in registers, copy it to a stack slot.  Handle
  /* If a BLKmode arrives in registers, copy it to a stack slot.  Handle
     calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.  */
     calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.  */
  if (REG_P (entry_parm) || GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
  if (REG_P (entry_parm) || GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
    {
    {
      rtx mem;
      rtx mem;
 
 
      /* Note that we will be storing an integral number of words.
      /* Note that we will be storing an integral number of words.
         So we have to be careful to ensure that we allocate an
         So we have to be careful to ensure that we allocate an
         integral number of words.  We do this above when we call
         integral number of words.  We do this above when we call
         assign_stack_local if space was not allocated in the argument
         assign_stack_local if space was not allocated in the argument
         list.  If it was, this will not work if PARM_BOUNDARY is not
         list.  If it was, this will not work if PARM_BOUNDARY is not
         a multiple of BITS_PER_WORD.  It isn't clear how to fix this
         a multiple of BITS_PER_WORD.  It isn't clear how to fix this
         if it becomes a problem.  Exception is when BLKmode arrives
         if it becomes a problem.  Exception is when BLKmode arrives
         with arguments not conforming to word_mode.  */
         with arguments not conforming to word_mode.  */
 
 
      if (data->stack_parm == 0)
      if (data->stack_parm == 0)
        ;
        ;
      else if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
      else if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
        ;
        ;
      else
      else
        gcc_assert (!size || !(PARM_BOUNDARY % BITS_PER_WORD));
        gcc_assert (!size || !(PARM_BOUNDARY % BITS_PER_WORD));
 
 
      mem = validize_mem (stack_parm);
      mem = validize_mem (stack_parm);
 
 
      /* Handle values in multiple non-contiguous locations.  */
      /* Handle values in multiple non-contiguous locations.  */
      if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
      if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
        {
        {
          push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
          push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
          emit_group_store (mem, entry_parm, data->passed_type, size);
          emit_group_store (mem, entry_parm, data->passed_type, size);
          all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
          all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
          end_sequence ();
          end_sequence ();
        }
        }
 
 
      else if (size == 0)
      else if (size == 0)
        ;
        ;
 
 
      /* If SIZE is that of a mode no bigger than a word, just use
      /* If SIZE is that of a mode no bigger than a word, just use
         that mode's store operation.  */
         that mode's store operation.  */
      else if (size <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
      else if (size <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
        {
        {
          enum machine_mode mode
          enum machine_mode mode
            = mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 0);
            = mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 0);
 
 
          if (mode != BLKmode
          if (mode != BLKmode
#ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
#ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
              && (size == UNITS_PER_WORD
              && (size == UNITS_PER_WORD
                  || (BLOCK_REG_PADDING (mode, data->passed_type, 1)
                  || (BLOCK_REG_PADDING (mode, data->passed_type, 1)
                      != (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)))
                      != (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)))
#endif
#endif
              )
              )
            {
            {
              rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (entry_parm));
              rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (entry_parm));
              emit_move_insn (change_address (mem, mode, 0), reg);
              emit_move_insn (change_address (mem, mode, 0), reg);
            }
            }
 
 
          /* Blocks smaller than a word on a BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
          /* Blocks smaller than a word on a BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
             machine must be aligned to the left before storing
             machine must be aligned to the left before storing
             to memory.  Note that the previous test doesn't
             to memory.  Note that the previous test doesn't
             handle all cases (e.g. SIZE == 3).  */
             handle all cases (e.g. SIZE == 3).  */
          else if (size != UNITS_PER_WORD
          else if (size != UNITS_PER_WORD
#ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
#ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
                   && (BLOCK_REG_PADDING (mode, data->passed_type, 1)
                   && (BLOCK_REG_PADDING (mode, data->passed_type, 1)
                       == downward)
                       == downward)
#else
#else
                   && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
                   && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
#endif
#endif
                   )
                   )
            {
            {
              rtx tem, x;
              rtx tem, x;
              int by = (UNITS_PER_WORD - size) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
              int by = (UNITS_PER_WORD - size) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
              rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, REGNO (entry_parm));
              rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, REGNO (entry_parm));
 
 
              x = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, word_mode, reg,
              x = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, word_mode, reg,
                                build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, by),
                                build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, by),
                                NULL_RTX, 1);
                                NULL_RTX, 1);
              tem = change_address (mem, word_mode, 0);
              tem = change_address (mem, word_mode, 0);
              emit_move_insn (tem, x);
              emit_move_insn (tem, x);
            }
            }
          else
          else
            move_block_from_reg (REGNO (entry_parm), mem,
            move_block_from_reg (REGNO (entry_parm), mem,
                                 size_stored / UNITS_PER_WORD);
                                 size_stored / UNITS_PER_WORD);
        }
        }
      else
      else
        move_block_from_reg (REGNO (entry_parm), mem,
        move_block_from_reg (REGNO (entry_parm), mem,
                             size_stored / UNITS_PER_WORD);
                             size_stored / UNITS_PER_WORD);
    }
    }
  else if (data->stack_parm == 0)
  else if (data->stack_parm == 0)
    {
    {
      push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
      push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
      emit_block_move (stack_parm, data->entry_parm, GEN_INT (size),
      emit_block_move (stack_parm, data->entry_parm, GEN_INT (size),
                       BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
                       BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
      all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
      all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
      end_sequence ();
      end_sequence ();
    }
    }
 
 
  data->stack_parm = stack_parm;
  data->stack_parm = stack_parm;
  SET_DECL_RTL (parm, stack_parm);
  SET_DECL_RTL (parm, stack_parm);
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Allocate a pseudo to hold the current
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Allocate a pseudo to hold the current
   parameter.  Get it there.  Perform all ABI specified conversions.  */
   parameter.  Get it there.  Perform all ABI specified conversions.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parm_setup_reg (struct assign_parm_data_all *all, tree parm,
assign_parm_setup_reg (struct assign_parm_data_all *all, tree parm,
                       struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
                       struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  rtx parmreg;
  rtx parmreg;
  enum machine_mode promoted_nominal_mode;
  enum machine_mode promoted_nominal_mode;
  int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (parm));
  int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (parm));
  bool did_conversion = false;
  bool did_conversion = false;
 
 
  /* Store the parm in a pseudoregister during the function, but we may
  /* Store the parm in a pseudoregister during the function, but we may
     need to do it in a wider mode.  */
     need to do it in a wider mode.  */
 
 
  /* This is not really promoting for a call.  However we need to be
  /* This is not really promoting for a call.  However we need to be
     consistent with assign_parm_find_data_types and expand_expr_real_1.  */
     consistent with assign_parm_find_data_types and expand_expr_real_1.  */
  promoted_nominal_mode
  promoted_nominal_mode
    = promote_mode (data->nominal_type, data->nominal_mode, &unsignedp, 1);
    = promote_mode (data->nominal_type, data->nominal_mode, &unsignedp, 1);
 
 
  parmreg = gen_reg_rtx (promoted_nominal_mode);
  parmreg = gen_reg_rtx (promoted_nominal_mode);
 
 
  if (!DECL_ARTIFICIAL (parm))
  if (!DECL_ARTIFICIAL (parm))
    mark_user_reg (parmreg);
    mark_user_reg (parmreg);
 
 
  /* If this was an item that we received a pointer to,
  /* If this was an item that we received a pointer to,
     set DECL_RTL appropriately.  */
     set DECL_RTL appropriately.  */
  if (data->passed_pointer)
  if (data->passed_pointer)
    {
    {
      rtx x = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (data->passed_type)), parmreg);
      rtx x = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (data->passed_type)), parmreg);
      set_mem_attributes (x, parm, 1);
      set_mem_attributes (x, parm, 1);
      SET_DECL_RTL (parm, x);
      SET_DECL_RTL (parm, x);
    }
    }
  else
  else
    SET_DECL_RTL (parm, parmreg);
    SET_DECL_RTL (parm, parmreg);
 
 
  /* Copy the value into the register.  */
  /* Copy the value into the register.  */
  if (data->nominal_mode != data->passed_mode
  if (data->nominal_mode != data->passed_mode
      || promoted_nominal_mode != data->promoted_mode)
      || promoted_nominal_mode != data->promoted_mode)
    {
    {
      int save_tree_used;
      int save_tree_used;
 
 
      /* ENTRY_PARM has been converted to PROMOTED_MODE, its
      /* ENTRY_PARM has been converted to PROMOTED_MODE, its
         mode, by the caller.  We now have to convert it to
         mode, by the caller.  We now have to convert it to
         NOMINAL_MODE, if different.  However, PARMREG may be in
         NOMINAL_MODE, if different.  However, PARMREG may be in
         a different mode than NOMINAL_MODE if it is being stored
         a different mode than NOMINAL_MODE if it is being stored
         promoted.
         promoted.
 
 
         If ENTRY_PARM is a hard register, it might be in a register
         If ENTRY_PARM is a hard register, it might be in a register
         not valid for operating in its mode (e.g., an odd-numbered
         not valid for operating in its mode (e.g., an odd-numbered
         register for a DFmode).  In that case, moves are the only
         register for a DFmode).  In that case, moves are the only
         thing valid, so we can't do a convert from there.  This
         thing valid, so we can't do a convert from there.  This
         occurs when the calling sequence allow such misaligned
         occurs when the calling sequence allow such misaligned
         usages.
         usages.
 
 
         In addition, the conversion may involve a call, which could
         In addition, the conversion may involve a call, which could
         clobber parameters which haven't been copied to pseudo
         clobber parameters which haven't been copied to pseudo
         registers yet.  Therefore, we must first copy the parm to
         registers yet.  Therefore, we must first copy the parm to
         a pseudo reg here, and save the conversion until after all
         a pseudo reg here, and save the conversion until after all
         parameters have been moved.  */
         parameters have been moved.  */
 
 
      rtx tempreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm));
      rtx tempreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm));
 
 
      emit_move_insn (tempreg, validize_mem (data->entry_parm));
      emit_move_insn (tempreg, validize_mem (data->entry_parm));
 
 
      push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
      push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
      tempreg = convert_to_mode (data->nominal_mode, tempreg, unsignedp);
      tempreg = convert_to_mode (data->nominal_mode, tempreg, unsignedp);
 
 
      if (GET_CODE (tempreg) == SUBREG
      if (GET_CODE (tempreg) == SUBREG
          && GET_MODE (tempreg) == data->nominal_mode
          && GET_MODE (tempreg) == data->nominal_mode
          && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (tempreg))
          && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (tempreg))
          && data->nominal_mode == data->passed_mode
          && data->nominal_mode == data->passed_mode
          && GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tempreg)) == GET_MODE (data->entry_parm)
          && GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tempreg)) == GET_MODE (data->entry_parm)
          && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (tempreg))
          && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (tempreg))
             < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm)))
             < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm)))
        {
        {
          /* The argument is already sign/zero extended, so note it
          /* The argument is already sign/zero extended, so note it
             into the subreg.  */
             into the subreg.  */
          SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (tempreg) = 1;
          SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (tempreg) = 1;
          SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (tempreg, unsignedp);
          SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (tempreg, unsignedp);
        }
        }
 
 
      /* TREE_USED gets set erroneously during expand_assignment.  */
      /* TREE_USED gets set erroneously during expand_assignment.  */
      save_tree_used = TREE_USED (parm);
      save_tree_used = TREE_USED (parm);
      expand_assignment (parm, make_tree (data->nominal_type, tempreg));
      expand_assignment (parm, make_tree (data->nominal_type, tempreg));
      TREE_USED (parm) = save_tree_used;
      TREE_USED (parm) = save_tree_used;
      all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
      all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
      end_sequence ();
      end_sequence ();
 
 
      did_conversion = true;
      did_conversion = true;
    }
    }
  else
  else
    emit_move_insn (parmreg, validize_mem (data->entry_parm));
    emit_move_insn (parmreg, validize_mem (data->entry_parm));
 
 
  /* If we were passed a pointer but the actual value can safely live
  /* If we were passed a pointer but the actual value can safely live
     in a register, put it in one.  */
     in a register, put it in one.  */
  if (data->passed_pointer
  if (data->passed_pointer
      && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) != BLKmode
      && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) != BLKmode
      /* If by-reference argument was promoted, demote it.  */
      /* If by-reference argument was promoted, demote it.  */
      && (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) != GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (parm))
      && (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) != GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (parm))
          || use_register_for_decl (parm)))
          || use_register_for_decl (parm)))
    {
    {
      /* We can't use nominal_mode, because it will have been set to
      /* We can't use nominal_mode, because it will have been set to
         Pmode above.  We must use the actual mode of the parm.  */
         Pmode above.  We must use the actual mode of the parm.  */
      parmreg = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
      parmreg = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
      mark_user_reg (parmreg);
      mark_user_reg (parmreg);
 
 
      if (GET_MODE (parmreg) != GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (parm)))
      if (GET_MODE (parmreg) != GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (parm)))
        {
        {
          rtx tempreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (parm)));
          rtx tempreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (parm)));
          int unsigned_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (parm));
          int unsigned_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (parm));
 
 
          push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
          push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
          emit_move_insn (tempreg, DECL_RTL (parm));
          emit_move_insn (tempreg, DECL_RTL (parm));
          tempreg = convert_to_mode (GET_MODE (parmreg), tempreg, unsigned_p);
          tempreg = convert_to_mode (GET_MODE (parmreg), tempreg, unsigned_p);
          emit_move_insn (parmreg, tempreg);
          emit_move_insn (parmreg, tempreg);
          all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
          all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
          end_sequence ();
          end_sequence ();
 
 
          did_conversion = true;
          did_conversion = true;
        }
        }
      else
      else
        emit_move_insn (parmreg, DECL_RTL (parm));
        emit_move_insn (parmreg, DECL_RTL (parm));
 
 
      SET_DECL_RTL (parm, parmreg);
      SET_DECL_RTL (parm, parmreg);
 
 
      /* STACK_PARM is the pointer, not the parm, and PARMREG is
      /* STACK_PARM is the pointer, not the parm, and PARMREG is
         now the parm.  */
         now the parm.  */
      data->stack_parm = NULL;
      data->stack_parm = NULL;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Mark the register as eliminable if we did no conversion and it was
  /* Mark the register as eliminable if we did no conversion and it was
     copied from memory at a fixed offset, and the arg pointer was not
     copied from memory at a fixed offset, and the arg pointer was not
     copied to a pseudo-reg.  If the arg pointer is a pseudo reg or the
     copied to a pseudo-reg.  If the arg pointer is a pseudo reg or the
     offset formed an invalid address, such memory-equivalences as we
     offset formed an invalid address, such memory-equivalences as we
     make here would screw up life analysis for it.  */
     make here would screw up life analysis for it.  */
  if (data->nominal_mode == data->passed_mode
  if (data->nominal_mode == data->passed_mode
      && !did_conversion
      && !did_conversion
      && data->stack_parm != 0
      && data->stack_parm != 0
      && MEM_P (data->stack_parm)
      && MEM_P (data->stack_parm)
      && data->locate.offset.var == 0
      && data->locate.offset.var == 0
      && reg_mentioned_p (virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
      && reg_mentioned_p (virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
                          XEXP (data->stack_parm, 0)))
                          XEXP (data->stack_parm, 0)))
    {
    {
      rtx linsn = get_last_insn ();
      rtx linsn = get_last_insn ();
      rtx sinsn, set;
      rtx sinsn, set;
 
 
      /* Mark complex types separately.  */
      /* Mark complex types separately.  */
      if (GET_CODE (parmreg) == CONCAT)
      if (GET_CODE (parmreg) == CONCAT)
        {
        {
          enum machine_mode submode
          enum machine_mode submode
            = GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (parmreg));
            = GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (parmreg));
          int regnor = REGNO (XEXP (parmreg, 0));
          int regnor = REGNO (XEXP (parmreg, 0));
          int regnoi = REGNO (XEXP (parmreg, 1));
          int regnoi = REGNO (XEXP (parmreg, 1));
          rtx stackr = adjust_address_nv (data->stack_parm, submode, 0);
          rtx stackr = adjust_address_nv (data->stack_parm, submode, 0);
          rtx stacki = adjust_address_nv (data->stack_parm, submode,
          rtx stacki = adjust_address_nv (data->stack_parm, submode,
                                          GET_MODE_SIZE (submode));
                                          GET_MODE_SIZE (submode));
 
 
          /* Scan backwards for the set of the real and
          /* Scan backwards for the set of the real and
             imaginary parts.  */
             imaginary parts.  */
          for (sinsn = linsn; sinsn != 0;
          for (sinsn = linsn; sinsn != 0;
               sinsn = prev_nonnote_insn (sinsn))
               sinsn = prev_nonnote_insn (sinsn))
            {
            {
              set = single_set (sinsn);
              set = single_set (sinsn);
              if (set == 0)
              if (set == 0)
                continue;
                continue;
 
 
              if (SET_DEST (set) == regno_reg_rtx [regnoi])
              if (SET_DEST (set) == regno_reg_rtx [regnoi])
                REG_NOTES (sinsn)
                REG_NOTES (sinsn)
                  = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, stacki,
                  = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, stacki,
                                       REG_NOTES (sinsn));
                                       REG_NOTES (sinsn));
              else if (SET_DEST (set) == regno_reg_rtx [regnor])
              else if (SET_DEST (set) == regno_reg_rtx [regnor])
                REG_NOTES (sinsn)
                REG_NOTES (sinsn)
                  = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, stackr,
                  = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV, stackr,
                                       REG_NOTES (sinsn));
                                       REG_NOTES (sinsn));
            }
            }
        }
        }
      else if ((set = single_set (linsn)) != 0
      else if ((set = single_set (linsn)) != 0
               && SET_DEST (set) == parmreg)
               && SET_DEST (set) == parmreg)
        REG_NOTES (linsn)
        REG_NOTES (linsn)
          = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV,
          = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV,
                               data->stack_parm, REG_NOTES (linsn));
                               data->stack_parm, REG_NOTES (linsn));
    }
    }
 
 
  /* For pointer data type, suggest pointer register.  */
  /* For pointer data type, suggest pointer register.  */
  if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (parm)))
  if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (parm)))
    mark_reg_pointer (parmreg,
    mark_reg_pointer (parmreg,
                      TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm))));
                      TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm))));
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Allocate stack space to hold the current
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  Allocate stack space to hold the current
   parameter.  Get it there.  Perform all ABI specified conversions.  */
   parameter.  Get it there.  Perform all ABI specified conversions.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parm_setup_stack (struct assign_parm_data_all *all, tree parm,
assign_parm_setup_stack (struct assign_parm_data_all *all, tree parm,
                         struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
                         struct assign_parm_data_one *data)
{
{
  /* Value must be stored in the stack slot STACK_PARM during function
  /* Value must be stored in the stack slot STACK_PARM during function
     execution.  */
     execution.  */
  bool to_conversion = false;
  bool to_conversion = false;
 
 
  if (data->promoted_mode != data->nominal_mode)
  if (data->promoted_mode != data->nominal_mode)
    {
    {
      /* Conversion is required.  */
      /* Conversion is required.  */
      rtx tempreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm));
      rtx tempreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm));
 
 
      emit_move_insn (tempreg, validize_mem (data->entry_parm));
      emit_move_insn (tempreg, validize_mem (data->entry_parm));
 
 
      push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
      push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
      to_conversion = true;
      to_conversion = true;
 
 
      data->entry_parm = convert_to_mode (data->nominal_mode, tempreg,
      data->entry_parm = convert_to_mode (data->nominal_mode, tempreg,
                                          TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
                                          TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
 
 
      if (data->stack_parm)
      if (data->stack_parm)
        /* ??? This may need a big-endian conversion on sparc64.  */
        /* ??? This may need a big-endian conversion on sparc64.  */
        data->stack_parm
        data->stack_parm
          = adjust_address (data->stack_parm, data->nominal_mode, 0);
          = adjust_address (data->stack_parm, data->nominal_mode, 0);
    }
    }
 
 
  if (data->entry_parm != data->stack_parm)
  if (data->entry_parm != data->stack_parm)
    {
    {
      rtx src, dest;
      rtx src, dest;
 
 
      if (data->stack_parm == 0)
      if (data->stack_parm == 0)
        {
        {
          data->stack_parm
          data->stack_parm
            = assign_stack_local (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm),
            = assign_stack_local (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm),
                                  GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm)),
                                  GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (data->entry_parm)),
                                  TYPE_ALIGN (data->passed_type));
                                  TYPE_ALIGN (data->passed_type));
          set_mem_attributes (data->stack_parm, parm, 1);
          set_mem_attributes (data->stack_parm, parm, 1);
        }
        }
 
 
      dest = validize_mem (data->stack_parm);
      dest = validize_mem (data->stack_parm);
      src = validize_mem (data->entry_parm);
      src = validize_mem (data->entry_parm);
 
 
      if (MEM_P (src))
      if (MEM_P (src))
        {
        {
          /* Use a block move to handle potentially misaligned entry_parm.  */
          /* Use a block move to handle potentially misaligned entry_parm.  */
          if (!to_conversion)
          if (!to_conversion)
            push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
            push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
          to_conversion = true;
          to_conversion = true;
 
 
          emit_block_move (dest, src,
          emit_block_move (dest, src,
                           GEN_INT (int_size_in_bytes (data->passed_type)),
                           GEN_INT (int_size_in_bytes (data->passed_type)),
                           BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
                           BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
        }
        }
      else
      else
        emit_move_insn (dest, src);
        emit_move_insn (dest, src);
    }
    }
 
 
  if (to_conversion)
  if (to_conversion)
    {
    {
      all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
      all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
      end_sequence ();
      end_sequence ();
    }
    }
 
 
  SET_DECL_RTL (parm, data->stack_parm);
  SET_DECL_RTL (parm, data->stack_parm);
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  If the ABI splits complex arguments, then
/* A subroutine of assign_parms.  If the ABI splits complex arguments, then
   undo the frobbing that we did in assign_parms_augmented_arg_list.  */
   undo the frobbing that we did in assign_parms_augmented_arg_list.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parms_unsplit_complex (struct assign_parm_data_all *all, tree fnargs)
assign_parms_unsplit_complex (struct assign_parm_data_all *all, tree fnargs)
{
{
  tree parm;
  tree parm;
  tree orig_fnargs = all->orig_fnargs;
  tree orig_fnargs = all->orig_fnargs;
 
 
  for (parm = orig_fnargs; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
  for (parm = orig_fnargs; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
    {
    {
      if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) == COMPLEX_TYPE
      if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) == COMPLEX_TYPE
          && targetm.calls.split_complex_arg (TREE_TYPE (parm)))
          && targetm.calls.split_complex_arg (TREE_TYPE (parm)))
        {
        {
          rtx tmp, real, imag;
          rtx tmp, real, imag;
          enum machine_mode inner = GET_MODE_INNER (DECL_MODE (parm));
          enum machine_mode inner = GET_MODE_INNER (DECL_MODE (parm));
 
 
          real = DECL_RTL (fnargs);
          real = DECL_RTL (fnargs);
          imag = DECL_RTL (TREE_CHAIN (fnargs));
          imag = DECL_RTL (TREE_CHAIN (fnargs));
          if (inner != GET_MODE (real))
          if (inner != GET_MODE (real))
            {
            {
              real = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (inner, real);
              real = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (inner, real);
              imag = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (inner, imag);
              imag = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (inner, imag);
            }
            }
 
 
          if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (parm))
          if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (parm))
            {
            {
              rtx rmem, imem;
              rtx rmem, imem;
              HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (parm));
              HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (parm));
 
 
              /* split_complex_arg put the real and imag parts in
              /* split_complex_arg put the real and imag parts in
                 pseudos.  Move them to memory.  */
                 pseudos.  Move them to memory.  */
              tmp = assign_stack_local (DECL_MODE (parm), size,
              tmp = assign_stack_local (DECL_MODE (parm), size,
                                        TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
                                        TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
              set_mem_attributes (tmp, parm, 1);
              set_mem_attributes (tmp, parm, 1);
              rmem = adjust_address_nv (tmp, inner, 0);
              rmem = adjust_address_nv (tmp, inner, 0);
              imem = adjust_address_nv (tmp, inner, GET_MODE_SIZE (inner));
              imem = adjust_address_nv (tmp, inner, GET_MODE_SIZE (inner));
              push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
              push_to_sequence (all->conversion_insns);
              emit_move_insn (rmem, real);
              emit_move_insn (rmem, real);
              emit_move_insn (imem, imag);
              emit_move_insn (imem, imag);
              all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
              all->conversion_insns = get_insns ();
              end_sequence ();
              end_sequence ();
            }
            }
          else
          else
            tmp = gen_rtx_CONCAT (DECL_MODE (parm), real, imag);
            tmp = gen_rtx_CONCAT (DECL_MODE (parm), real, imag);
          SET_DECL_RTL (parm, tmp);
          SET_DECL_RTL (parm, tmp);
 
 
          real = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (fnargs);
          real = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (fnargs);
          imag = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (TREE_CHAIN (fnargs));
          imag = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (TREE_CHAIN (fnargs));
          if (inner != GET_MODE (real))
          if (inner != GET_MODE (real))
            {
            {
              real = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (inner, real);
              real = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (inner, real);
              imag = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (inner, imag);
              imag = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (inner, imag);
            }
            }
          tmp = gen_rtx_CONCAT (DECL_MODE (parm), real, imag);
          tmp = gen_rtx_CONCAT (DECL_MODE (parm), real, imag);
          set_decl_incoming_rtl (parm, tmp);
          set_decl_incoming_rtl (parm, tmp);
          fnargs = TREE_CHAIN (fnargs);
          fnargs = TREE_CHAIN (fnargs);
        }
        }
      else
      else
        {
        {
          SET_DECL_RTL (parm, DECL_RTL (fnargs));
          SET_DECL_RTL (parm, DECL_RTL (fnargs));
          set_decl_incoming_rtl (parm, DECL_INCOMING_RTL (fnargs));
          set_decl_incoming_rtl (parm, DECL_INCOMING_RTL (fnargs));
 
 
          /* Set MEM_EXPR to the original decl, i.e. to PARM,
          /* Set MEM_EXPR to the original decl, i.e. to PARM,
             instead of the copy of decl, i.e. FNARGS.  */
             instead of the copy of decl, i.e. FNARGS.  */
          if (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm) && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm)))
          if (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm) && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm)))
            set_mem_expr (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm), parm);
            set_mem_expr (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm), parm);
        }
        }
 
 
      fnargs = TREE_CHAIN (fnargs);
      fnargs = TREE_CHAIN (fnargs);
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
/* Assign RTL expressions to the function's parameters.  This may involve
/* Assign RTL expressions to the function's parameters.  This may involve
   copying them into registers and using those registers as the DECL_RTL.  */
   copying them into registers and using those registers as the DECL_RTL.  */
 
 
static void
static void
assign_parms (tree fndecl)
assign_parms (tree fndecl)
{
{
  struct assign_parm_data_all all;
  struct assign_parm_data_all all;
  tree fnargs, parm;
  tree fnargs, parm;
 
 
  current_function_internal_arg_pointer
  current_function_internal_arg_pointer
    = targetm.calls.internal_arg_pointer ();
    = targetm.calls.internal_arg_pointer ();
 
 
  assign_parms_initialize_all (&all);
  assign_parms_initialize_all (&all);
  fnargs = assign_parms_augmented_arg_list (&all);
  fnargs = assign_parms_augmented_arg_list (&all);
 
 
  for (parm = fnargs; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
  for (parm = fnargs; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
    {
    {
      struct assign_parm_data_one data;
      struct assign_parm_data_one data;
 
 
      /* Extract the type of PARM; adjust it according to ABI.  */
      /* Extract the type of PARM; adjust it according to ABI.  */
      assign_parm_find_data_types (&all, parm, &data);
      assign_parm_find_data_types (&all, parm, &data);
 
 
      /* Early out for errors and void parameters.  */
      /* Early out for errors and void parameters.  */
      if (data.passed_mode == VOIDmode)
      if (data.passed_mode == VOIDmode)
        {
        {
          SET_DECL_RTL (parm, const0_rtx);
          SET_DECL_RTL (parm, const0_rtx);
          DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm) = DECL_RTL (parm);
          DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm) = DECL_RTL (parm);
          continue;
          continue;
        }
        }
 
 
      if (current_function_stdarg && !TREE_CHAIN (parm))
      if (current_function_stdarg && !TREE_CHAIN (parm))
        assign_parms_setup_varargs (&all, &data, false);
        assign_parms_setup_varargs (&all, &data, false);
 
 
      /* Find out where the parameter arrives in this function.  */
      /* Find out where the parameter arrives in this function.  */
      assign_parm_find_entry_rtl (&all, &data);
      assign_parm_find_entry_rtl (&all, &data);
 
 
      /* Find out where stack space for this parameter might be.  */
      /* Find out where stack space for this parameter might be.  */
      if (assign_parm_is_stack_parm (&all, &data))
      if (assign_parm_is_stack_parm (&all, &data))
        {
        {
          assign_parm_find_stack_rtl (parm, &data);
          assign_parm_find_stack_rtl (parm, &data);
          assign_parm_adjust_entry_rtl (&data);
          assign_parm_adjust_entry_rtl (&data);
        }
        }
 
 
      /* Record permanently how this parm was passed.  */
      /* Record permanently how this parm was passed.  */
      set_decl_incoming_rtl (parm, data.entry_parm);
      set_decl_incoming_rtl (parm, data.entry_parm);
 
 
      /* Update info on where next arg arrives in registers.  */
      /* Update info on where next arg arrives in registers.  */
      FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (all.args_so_far, data.promoted_mode,
      FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (all.args_so_far, data.promoted_mode,
                            data.passed_type, data.named_arg);
                            data.passed_type, data.named_arg);
 
 
      assign_parm_adjust_stack_rtl (&data);
      assign_parm_adjust_stack_rtl (&data);
 
 
      if (assign_parm_setup_block_p (&data))
      if (assign_parm_setup_block_p (&data))
        assign_parm_setup_block (&all, parm, &data);
        assign_parm_setup_block (&all, parm, &data);
      else if (data.passed_pointer || use_register_for_decl (parm))
      else if (data.passed_pointer || use_register_for_decl (parm))
        assign_parm_setup_reg (&all, parm, &data);
        assign_parm_setup_reg (&all, parm, &data);
      else
      else
        assign_parm_setup_stack (&all, parm, &data);
        assign_parm_setup_stack (&all, parm, &data);
    }
    }
 
 
  if (targetm.calls.split_complex_arg && fnargs != all.orig_fnargs)
  if (targetm.calls.split_complex_arg && fnargs != all.orig_fnargs)
    assign_parms_unsplit_complex (&all, fnargs);
    assign_parms_unsplit_complex (&all, fnargs);
 
 
  /* Output all parameter conversion instructions (possibly including calls)
  /* Output all parameter conversion instructions (possibly including calls)
     now that all parameters have been copied out of hard registers.  */
     now that all parameters have been copied out of hard registers.  */
  emit_insn (all.conversion_insns);
  emit_insn (all.conversion_insns);
 
 
  /* If we are receiving a struct value address as the first argument, set up
  /* If we are receiving a struct value address as the first argument, set up
     the RTL for the function result. As this might require code to convert
     the RTL for the function result. As this might require code to convert
     the transmitted address to Pmode, we do this here to ensure that possible
     the transmitted address to Pmode, we do this here to ensure that possible
     preliminary conversions of the address have been emitted already.  */
     preliminary conversions of the address have been emitted already.  */
  if (all.function_result_decl)
  if (all.function_result_decl)
    {
    {
      tree result = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
      tree result = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
      rtx addr = DECL_RTL (all.function_result_decl);
      rtx addr = DECL_RTL (all.function_result_decl);
      rtx x;
      rtx x;
 
 
      if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (result))
      if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (result))
        x = addr;
        x = addr;
      else
      else
        {
        {
          addr = convert_memory_address (Pmode, addr);
          addr = convert_memory_address (Pmode, addr);
          x = gen_rtx_MEM (DECL_MODE (result), addr);
          x = gen_rtx_MEM (DECL_MODE (result), addr);
          set_mem_attributes (x, result, 1);
          set_mem_attributes (x, result, 1);
        }
        }
      SET_DECL_RTL (result, x);
      SET_DECL_RTL (result, x);
    }
    }
 
 
  /* We have aligned all the args, so add space for the pretend args.  */
  /* We have aligned all the args, so add space for the pretend args.  */
  current_function_pretend_args_size = all.pretend_args_size;
  current_function_pretend_args_size = all.pretend_args_size;
  all.stack_args_size.constant += all.extra_pretend_bytes;
  all.stack_args_size.constant += all.extra_pretend_bytes;
  current_function_args_size = all.stack_args_size.constant;
  current_function_args_size = all.stack_args_size.constant;
 
 
  /* Adjust function incoming argument size for alignment and
  /* Adjust function incoming argument size for alignment and
     minimum length.  */
     minimum length.  */
 
 
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
  current_function_args_size = MAX (current_function_args_size,
  current_function_args_size = MAX (current_function_args_size,
                                    REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl));
                                    REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl));
#endif
#endif
 
 
  current_function_args_size = CEIL_ROUND (current_function_args_size,
  current_function_args_size = CEIL_ROUND (current_function_args_size,
                                           PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
                                           PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
 
 
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
  current_function_arg_offset_rtx
  current_function_arg_offset_rtx
    = (all.stack_args_size.var == 0 ? GEN_INT (-all.stack_args_size.constant)
    = (all.stack_args_size.var == 0 ? GEN_INT (-all.stack_args_size.constant)
       : expand_expr (size_diffop (all.stack_args_size.var,
       : expand_expr (size_diffop (all.stack_args_size.var,
                                   size_int (-all.stack_args_size.constant)),
                                   size_int (-all.stack_args_size.constant)),
                      NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0));
                      NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0));
#else
#else
  current_function_arg_offset_rtx = ARGS_SIZE_RTX (all.stack_args_size);
  current_function_arg_offset_rtx = ARGS_SIZE_RTX (all.stack_args_size);
#endif
#endif
 
 
  /* See how many bytes, if any, of its args a function should try to pop
  /* See how many bytes, if any, of its args a function should try to pop
     on return.  */
     on return.  */
 
 
  current_function_pops_args = RETURN_POPS_ARGS (fndecl, TREE_TYPE (fndecl),
  current_function_pops_args = RETURN_POPS_ARGS (fndecl, TREE_TYPE (fndecl),
                                                 current_function_args_size);
                                                 current_function_args_size);
 
 
  /* For stdarg.h function, save info about
  /* For stdarg.h function, save info about
     regs and stack space used by the named args.  */
     regs and stack space used by the named args.  */
 
 
  current_function_args_info = all.args_so_far;
  current_function_args_info = all.args_so_far;
 
 
  /* Set the rtx used for the function return value.  Put this in its
  /* Set the rtx used for the function return value.  Put this in its
     own variable so any optimizers that need this information don't have
     own variable so any optimizers that need this information don't have
     to include tree.h.  Do this here so it gets done when an inlined
     to include tree.h.  Do this here so it gets done when an inlined
     function gets output.  */
     function gets output.  */
 
 
  current_function_return_rtx
  current_function_return_rtx
    = (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
    = (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
       ? DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (fndecl)) : NULL_RTX);
       ? DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (fndecl)) : NULL_RTX);
 
 
  /* If scalar return value was computed in a pseudo-reg, or was a named
  /* If scalar return value was computed in a pseudo-reg, or was a named
     return value that got dumped to the stack, copy that to the hard
     return value that got dumped to the stack, copy that to the hard
     return register.  */
     return register.  */
  if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (fndecl)))
  if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (fndecl)))
    {
    {
      tree decl_result = DECL_RESULT (fndecl);
      tree decl_result = DECL_RESULT (fndecl);
      rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (decl_result);
      rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (decl_result);
 
 
      if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
      if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
          ? REGNO (decl_rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
          ? REGNO (decl_rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
          : DECL_REGISTER (decl_result))
          : DECL_REGISTER (decl_result))
        {
        {
          rtx real_decl_rtl;
          rtx real_decl_rtl;
 
 
          real_decl_rtl = targetm.calls.function_value (TREE_TYPE (decl_result),
          real_decl_rtl = targetm.calls.function_value (TREE_TYPE (decl_result),
                                                        fndecl, true);
                                                        fndecl, true);
          REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (real_decl_rtl) = 1;
          REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (real_decl_rtl) = 1;
          /* The delay slot scheduler assumes that current_function_return_rtx
          /* The delay slot scheduler assumes that current_function_return_rtx
             holds the hard register containing the return value, not a
             holds the hard register containing the return value, not a
             temporary pseudo.  */
             temporary pseudo.  */
          current_function_return_rtx = real_decl_rtl;
          current_function_return_rtx = real_decl_rtl;
        }
        }
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
/* A subroutine of gimplify_parameters, invoked via walk_tree.
/* A subroutine of gimplify_parameters, invoked via walk_tree.
   For all seen types, gimplify their sizes.  */
   For all seen types, gimplify their sizes.  */
 
 
static tree
static tree
gimplify_parm_type (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data)
gimplify_parm_type (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data)
{
{
  tree t = *tp;
  tree t = *tp;
 
 
  *walk_subtrees = 0;
  *walk_subtrees = 0;
  if (TYPE_P (t))
  if (TYPE_P (t))
    {
    {
      if (POINTER_TYPE_P (t))
      if (POINTER_TYPE_P (t))
        *walk_subtrees = 1;
        *walk_subtrees = 1;
      else if (TYPE_SIZE (t) && !TREE_CONSTANT (TYPE_SIZE (t))
      else if (TYPE_SIZE (t) && !TREE_CONSTANT (TYPE_SIZE (t))
               && !TYPE_SIZES_GIMPLIFIED (t))
               && !TYPE_SIZES_GIMPLIFIED (t))
        {
        {
          gimplify_type_sizes (t, (tree *) data);
          gimplify_type_sizes (t, (tree *) data);
          *walk_subtrees = 1;
          *walk_subtrees = 1;
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  return NULL;
  return NULL;
}
}
 
 
/* Gimplify the parameter list for current_function_decl.  This involves
/* Gimplify the parameter list for current_function_decl.  This involves
   evaluating SAVE_EXPRs of variable sized parameters and generating code
   evaluating SAVE_EXPRs of variable sized parameters and generating code
   to implement callee-copies reference parameters.  Returns a list of
   to implement callee-copies reference parameters.  Returns a list of
   statements to add to the beginning of the function, or NULL if nothing
   statements to add to the beginning of the function, or NULL if nothing
   to do.  */
   to do.  */
 
 
tree
tree
gimplify_parameters (void)
gimplify_parameters (void)
{
{
  struct assign_parm_data_all all;
  struct assign_parm_data_all all;
  tree fnargs, parm, stmts = NULL;
  tree fnargs, parm, stmts = NULL;
 
 
  assign_parms_initialize_all (&all);
  assign_parms_initialize_all (&all);
  fnargs = assign_parms_augmented_arg_list (&all);
  fnargs = assign_parms_augmented_arg_list (&all);
 
 
  for (parm = fnargs; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
  for (parm = fnargs; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
    {
    {
      struct assign_parm_data_one data;
      struct assign_parm_data_one data;
 
 
      /* Extract the type of PARM; adjust it according to ABI.  */
      /* Extract the type of PARM; adjust it according to ABI.  */
      assign_parm_find_data_types (&all, parm, &data);
      assign_parm_find_data_types (&all, parm, &data);
 
 
      /* Early out for errors and void parameters.  */
      /* Early out for errors and void parameters.  */
      if (data.passed_mode == VOIDmode || DECL_SIZE (parm) == NULL)
      if (data.passed_mode == VOIDmode || DECL_SIZE (parm) == NULL)
        continue;
        continue;
 
 
      /* Update info on where next arg arrives in registers.  */
      /* Update info on where next arg arrives in registers.  */
      FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (all.args_so_far, data.promoted_mode,
      FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (all.args_so_far, data.promoted_mode,
                            data.passed_type, data.named_arg);
                            data.passed_type, data.named_arg);
 
 
      /* ??? Once upon a time variable_size stuffed parameter list
      /* ??? Once upon a time variable_size stuffed parameter list
         SAVE_EXPRs (amongst others) onto a pending sizes list.  This
         SAVE_EXPRs (amongst others) onto a pending sizes list.  This
         turned out to be less than manageable in the gimple world.
         turned out to be less than manageable in the gimple world.
         Now we have to hunt them down ourselves.  */
         Now we have to hunt them down ourselves.  */
      walk_tree_without_duplicates (&data.passed_type,
      walk_tree_without_duplicates (&data.passed_type,
                                    gimplify_parm_type, &stmts);
                                    gimplify_parm_type, &stmts);
 
 
      if (!TREE_CONSTANT (DECL_SIZE (parm)))
      if (!TREE_CONSTANT (DECL_SIZE (parm)))
        {
        {
          gimplify_one_sizepos (&DECL_SIZE (parm), &stmts);
          gimplify_one_sizepos (&DECL_SIZE (parm), &stmts);
          gimplify_one_sizepos (&DECL_SIZE_UNIT (parm), &stmts);
          gimplify_one_sizepos (&DECL_SIZE_UNIT (parm), &stmts);
        }
        }
 
 
      if (data.passed_pointer)
      if (data.passed_pointer)
        {
        {
          tree type = TREE_TYPE (data.passed_type);
          tree type = TREE_TYPE (data.passed_type);
          if (reference_callee_copied (&all.args_so_far, TYPE_MODE (type),
          if (reference_callee_copied (&all.args_so_far, TYPE_MODE (type),
                                       type, data.named_arg))
                                       type, data.named_arg))
            {
            {
              tree local, t;
              tree local, t;
 
 
              /* For constant sized objects, this is trivial; for
              /* For constant sized objects, this is trivial; for
                 variable-sized objects, we have to play games.  */
                 variable-sized objects, we have to play games.  */
              if (TREE_CONSTANT (DECL_SIZE (parm)))
              if (TREE_CONSTANT (DECL_SIZE (parm)))
                {
                {
                  local = create_tmp_var (type, get_name (parm));
                  local = create_tmp_var (type, get_name (parm));
                  DECL_IGNORED_P (local) = 0;
                  DECL_IGNORED_P (local) = 0;
                }
                }
              else
              else
                {
                {
                  tree ptr_type, addr, args;
                  tree ptr_type, addr, args;
 
 
                  ptr_type = build_pointer_type (type);
                  ptr_type = build_pointer_type (type);
                  addr = create_tmp_var (ptr_type, get_name (parm));
                  addr = create_tmp_var (ptr_type, get_name (parm));
                  DECL_IGNORED_P (addr) = 0;
                  DECL_IGNORED_P (addr) = 0;
                  local = build_fold_indirect_ref (addr);
                  local = build_fold_indirect_ref (addr);
 
 
                  args = tree_cons (NULL, DECL_SIZE_UNIT (parm), NULL);
                  args = tree_cons (NULL, DECL_SIZE_UNIT (parm), NULL);
                  t = built_in_decls[BUILT_IN_ALLOCA];
                  t = built_in_decls[BUILT_IN_ALLOCA];
                  t = build_function_call_expr (t, args);
                  t = build_function_call_expr (t, args);
                  t = fold_convert (ptr_type, t);
                  t = fold_convert (ptr_type, t);
                  t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, void_type_node, addr, t);
                  t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, void_type_node, addr, t);
                  gimplify_and_add (t, &stmts);
                  gimplify_and_add (t, &stmts);
                }
                }
 
 
              t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, void_type_node, local, parm);
              t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, void_type_node, local, parm);
              gimplify_and_add (t, &stmts);
              gimplify_and_add (t, &stmts);
 
 
              SET_DECL_VALUE_EXPR (parm, local);
              SET_DECL_VALUE_EXPR (parm, local);
              DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (parm) = 1;
              DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (parm) = 1;
            }
            }
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  return stmts;
  return stmts;
}
}


/* Indicate whether REGNO is an incoming argument to the current function
/* Indicate whether REGNO is an incoming argument to the current function
   that was promoted to a wider mode.  If so, return the RTX for the
   that was promoted to a wider mode.  If so, return the RTX for the
   register (to get its mode).  PMODE and PUNSIGNEDP are set to the mode
   register (to get its mode).  PMODE and PUNSIGNEDP are set to the mode
   that REGNO is promoted from and whether the promotion was signed or
   that REGNO is promoted from and whether the promotion was signed or
   unsigned.  */
   unsigned.  */
 
 
rtx
rtx
promoted_input_arg (unsigned int regno, enum machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp)
promoted_input_arg (unsigned int regno, enum machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp)
{
{
  tree arg;
  tree arg;
 
 
  for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl); arg;
  for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl); arg;
       arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
       arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
    if (REG_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg))
    if (REG_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg))
        && REGNO (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg)) == regno
        && REGNO (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg)) == regno
        && TYPE_MODE (DECL_ARG_TYPE (arg)) == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)))
        && TYPE_MODE (DECL_ARG_TYPE (arg)) == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)))
      {
      {
        enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg));
        enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg));
        int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (arg));
        int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (arg));
 
 
        mode = promote_mode (TREE_TYPE (arg), mode, &unsignedp, 1);
        mode = promote_mode (TREE_TYPE (arg), mode, &unsignedp, 1);
        if (mode == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg))
        if (mode == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg))
            && mode != DECL_MODE (arg))
            && mode != DECL_MODE (arg))
          {
          {
            *pmode = DECL_MODE (arg);
            *pmode = DECL_MODE (arg);
            *punsignedp = unsignedp;
            *punsignedp = unsignedp;
            return DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg);
            return DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg);
          }
          }
      }
      }
 
 
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}
 
 


/* Compute the size and offset from the start of the stacked arguments for a
/* Compute the size and offset from the start of the stacked arguments for a
   parm passed in mode PASSED_MODE and with type TYPE.
   parm passed in mode PASSED_MODE and with type TYPE.
 
 
   INITIAL_OFFSET_PTR points to the current offset into the stacked
   INITIAL_OFFSET_PTR points to the current offset into the stacked
   arguments.
   arguments.
 
 
   The starting offset and size for this parm are returned in
   The starting offset and size for this parm are returned in
   LOCATE->OFFSET and LOCATE->SIZE, respectively.  When IN_REGS is
   LOCATE->OFFSET and LOCATE->SIZE, respectively.  When IN_REGS is
   nonzero, the offset is that of stack slot, which is returned in
   nonzero, the offset is that of stack slot, which is returned in
   LOCATE->SLOT_OFFSET.  LOCATE->ALIGNMENT_PAD is the amount of
   LOCATE->SLOT_OFFSET.  LOCATE->ALIGNMENT_PAD is the amount of
   padding required from the initial offset ptr to the stack slot.
   padding required from the initial offset ptr to the stack slot.
 
 
   IN_REGS is nonzero if the argument will be passed in registers.  It will
   IN_REGS is nonzero if the argument will be passed in registers.  It will
   never be set if REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is not defined.
   never be set if REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is not defined.
 
 
   FNDECL is the function in which the argument was defined.
   FNDECL is the function in which the argument was defined.
 
 
   There are two types of rounding that are done.  The first, controlled by
   There are two types of rounding that are done.  The first, controlled by
   FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY, forces the offset from the start of the argument
   FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY, forces the offset from the start of the argument
   list to be aligned to the specific boundary (in bits).  This rounding
   list to be aligned to the specific boundary (in bits).  This rounding
   affects the initial and starting offsets, but not the argument size.
   affects the initial and starting offsets, but not the argument size.
 
 
   The second, controlled by FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING and PARM_BOUNDARY,
   The second, controlled by FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING and PARM_BOUNDARY,
   optionally rounds the size of the parm to PARM_BOUNDARY.  The
   optionally rounds the size of the parm to PARM_BOUNDARY.  The
   initial offset is not affected by this rounding, while the size always
   initial offset is not affected by this rounding, while the size always
   is and the starting offset may be.  */
   is and the starting offset may be.  */
 
 
/*  LOCATE->OFFSET will be negative for ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD case;
/*  LOCATE->OFFSET will be negative for ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD case;
    INITIAL_OFFSET_PTR is positive because locate_and_pad_parm's
    INITIAL_OFFSET_PTR is positive because locate_and_pad_parm's
    callers pass in the total size of args so far as
    callers pass in the total size of args so far as
    INITIAL_OFFSET_PTR.  LOCATE->SIZE is always positive.  */
    INITIAL_OFFSET_PTR.  LOCATE->SIZE is always positive.  */
 
 
void
void
locate_and_pad_parm (enum machine_mode passed_mode, tree type, int in_regs,
locate_and_pad_parm (enum machine_mode passed_mode, tree type, int in_regs,
                     int partial, tree fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
                     int partial, tree fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
                     struct args_size *initial_offset_ptr,
                     struct args_size *initial_offset_ptr,
                     struct locate_and_pad_arg_data *locate)
                     struct locate_and_pad_arg_data *locate)
{
{
  tree sizetree;
  tree sizetree;
  enum direction where_pad;
  enum direction where_pad;
  unsigned int boundary;
  unsigned int boundary;
  int reg_parm_stack_space = 0;
  int reg_parm_stack_space = 0;
  int part_size_in_regs;
  int part_size_in_regs;
 
 
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
  reg_parm_stack_space = REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl);
  reg_parm_stack_space = REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl);
 
 
  /* If we have found a stack parm before we reach the end of the
  /* If we have found a stack parm before we reach the end of the
     area reserved for registers, skip that area.  */
     area reserved for registers, skip that area.  */
  if (! in_regs)
  if (! in_regs)
    {
    {
      if (reg_parm_stack_space > 0)
      if (reg_parm_stack_space > 0)
        {
        {
          if (initial_offset_ptr->var)
          if (initial_offset_ptr->var)
            {
            {
              initial_offset_ptr->var
              initial_offset_ptr->var
                = size_binop (MAX_EXPR, ARGS_SIZE_TREE (*initial_offset_ptr),
                = size_binop (MAX_EXPR, ARGS_SIZE_TREE (*initial_offset_ptr),
                              ssize_int (reg_parm_stack_space));
                              ssize_int (reg_parm_stack_space));
              initial_offset_ptr->constant = 0;
              initial_offset_ptr->constant = 0;
            }
            }
          else if (initial_offset_ptr->constant < reg_parm_stack_space)
          else if (initial_offset_ptr->constant < reg_parm_stack_space)
            initial_offset_ptr->constant = reg_parm_stack_space;
            initial_offset_ptr->constant = reg_parm_stack_space;
        }
        }
    }
    }
#endif /* REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE */
#endif /* REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE */
 
 
  part_size_in_regs = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0 ? partial : 0);
  part_size_in_regs = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0 ? partial : 0);
 
 
  sizetree
  sizetree
    = type ? size_in_bytes (type) : size_int (GET_MODE_SIZE (passed_mode));
    = type ? size_in_bytes (type) : size_int (GET_MODE_SIZE (passed_mode));
  where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (passed_mode, type);
  where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (passed_mode, type);
  boundary = FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (passed_mode, type);
  boundary = FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (passed_mode, type);
  locate->where_pad = where_pad;
  locate->where_pad = where_pad;
  locate->boundary = boundary;
  locate->boundary = boundary;
 
 
  /* Remember if the outgoing parameter requires extra alignment on the
  /* Remember if the outgoing parameter requires extra alignment on the
     calling function side.  */
     calling function side.  */
  if (boundary > PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY)
  if (boundary > PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY)
    boundary = PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY;
    boundary = PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY;
  if (cfun->stack_alignment_needed < boundary)
  if (cfun->stack_alignment_needed < boundary)
    cfun->stack_alignment_needed = boundary;
    cfun->stack_alignment_needed = boundary;
 
 
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
  locate->slot_offset.constant = -initial_offset_ptr->constant;
  locate->slot_offset.constant = -initial_offset_ptr->constant;
  if (initial_offset_ptr->var)
  if (initial_offset_ptr->var)
    locate->slot_offset.var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, ssize_int (0),
    locate->slot_offset.var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, ssize_int (0),
                                          initial_offset_ptr->var);
                                          initial_offset_ptr->var);
 
 
  {
  {
    tree s2 = sizetree;
    tree s2 = sizetree;
    if (where_pad != none
    if (where_pad != none
        && (!host_integerp (sizetree, 1)
        && (!host_integerp (sizetree, 1)
            || (tree_low_cst (sizetree, 1) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY))
            || (tree_low_cst (sizetree, 1) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY))
      s2 = round_up (s2, PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
      s2 = round_up (s2, PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
    SUB_PARM_SIZE (locate->slot_offset, s2);
    SUB_PARM_SIZE (locate->slot_offset, s2);
  }
  }
 
 
  locate->slot_offset.constant += part_size_in_regs;
  locate->slot_offset.constant += part_size_in_regs;
 
 
  if (!in_regs
  if (!in_regs
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
      || REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl) > 0
      || REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl) > 0
#endif
#endif
     )
     )
    pad_to_arg_alignment (&locate->slot_offset, boundary,
    pad_to_arg_alignment (&locate->slot_offset, boundary,
                          &locate->alignment_pad);
                          &locate->alignment_pad);
 
 
  locate->size.constant = (-initial_offset_ptr->constant
  locate->size.constant = (-initial_offset_ptr->constant
                           - locate->slot_offset.constant);
                           - locate->slot_offset.constant);
  if (initial_offset_ptr->var)
  if (initial_offset_ptr->var)
    locate->size.var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
    locate->size.var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
                                   size_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
                                   size_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
                                               ssize_int (0),
                                               ssize_int (0),
                                               initial_offset_ptr->var),
                                               initial_offset_ptr->var),
                                   locate->slot_offset.var);
                                   locate->slot_offset.var);
 
 
  /* Pad_below needs the pre-rounded size to know how much to pad
  /* Pad_below needs the pre-rounded size to know how much to pad
     below.  */
     below.  */
  locate->offset = locate->slot_offset;
  locate->offset = locate->slot_offset;
  if (where_pad == downward)
  if (where_pad == downward)
    pad_below (&locate->offset, passed_mode, sizetree);
    pad_below (&locate->offset, passed_mode, sizetree);
 
 
#else /* !ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD */
#else /* !ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD */
  if (!in_regs
  if (!in_regs
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
      || REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl) > 0
      || REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl) > 0
#endif
#endif
      )
      )
    pad_to_arg_alignment (initial_offset_ptr, boundary,
    pad_to_arg_alignment (initial_offset_ptr, boundary,
                          &locate->alignment_pad);
                          &locate->alignment_pad);
  locate->slot_offset = *initial_offset_ptr;
  locate->slot_offset = *initial_offset_ptr;
 
 
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
  if (passed_mode != BLKmode)
  if (passed_mode != BLKmode)
    sizetree = size_int (PUSH_ROUNDING (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (sizetree)));
    sizetree = size_int (PUSH_ROUNDING (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (sizetree)));
#endif
#endif
 
 
  /* Pad_below needs the pre-rounded size to know how much to pad below
  /* Pad_below needs the pre-rounded size to know how much to pad below
     so this must be done before rounding up.  */
     so this must be done before rounding up.  */
  locate->offset = locate->slot_offset;
  locate->offset = locate->slot_offset;
  if (where_pad == downward)
  if (where_pad == downward)
    pad_below (&locate->offset, passed_mode, sizetree);
    pad_below (&locate->offset, passed_mode, sizetree);
 
 
  if (where_pad != none
  if (where_pad != none
      && (!host_integerp (sizetree, 1)
      && (!host_integerp (sizetree, 1)
          || (tree_low_cst (sizetree, 1) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY))
          || (tree_low_cst (sizetree, 1) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY))
    sizetree = round_up (sizetree, PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
    sizetree = round_up (sizetree, PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
 
 
  ADD_PARM_SIZE (locate->size, sizetree);
  ADD_PARM_SIZE (locate->size, sizetree);
 
 
  locate->size.constant -= part_size_in_regs;
  locate->size.constant -= part_size_in_regs;
#endif /* ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD */
#endif /* ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD */
}
}
 
 
/* Round the stack offset in *OFFSET_PTR up to a multiple of BOUNDARY.
/* Round the stack offset in *OFFSET_PTR up to a multiple of BOUNDARY.
   BOUNDARY is measured in bits, but must be a multiple of a storage unit.  */
   BOUNDARY is measured in bits, but must be a multiple of a storage unit.  */
 
 
static void
static void
pad_to_arg_alignment (struct args_size *offset_ptr, int boundary,
pad_to_arg_alignment (struct args_size *offset_ptr, int boundary,
                      struct args_size *alignment_pad)
                      struct args_size *alignment_pad)
{
{
  tree save_var = NULL_TREE;
  tree save_var = NULL_TREE;
  HOST_WIDE_INT save_constant = 0;
  HOST_WIDE_INT save_constant = 0;
  int boundary_in_bytes = boundary / BITS_PER_UNIT;
  int boundary_in_bytes = boundary / BITS_PER_UNIT;
  HOST_WIDE_INT sp_offset = STACK_POINTER_OFFSET;
  HOST_WIDE_INT sp_offset = STACK_POINTER_OFFSET;
 
 
#ifdef SPARC_STACK_BOUNDARY_HACK
#ifdef SPARC_STACK_BOUNDARY_HACK
  /* ??? The SPARC port may claim a STACK_BOUNDARY higher than
  /* ??? The SPARC port may claim a STACK_BOUNDARY higher than
     the real alignment of %sp.  However, when it does this, the
     the real alignment of %sp.  However, when it does this, the
     alignment of %sp+STACK_POINTER_OFFSET is STACK_BOUNDARY.  */
     alignment of %sp+STACK_POINTER_OFFSET is STACK_BOUNDARY.  */
  if (SPARC_STACK_BOUNDARY_HACK)
  if (SPARC_STACK_BOUNDARY_HACK)
    sp_offset = 0;
    sp_offset = 0;
#endif
#endif
 
 
  if (boundary > PARM_BOUNDARY && boundary > STACK_BOUNDARY)
  if (boundary > PARM_BOUNDARY && boundary > STACK_BOUNDARY)
    {
    {
      save_var = offset_ptr->var;
      save_var = offset_ptr->var;
      save_constant = offset_ptr->constant;
      save_constant = offset_ptr->constant;
    }
    }
 
 
  alignment_pad->var = NULL_TREE;
  alignment_pad->var = NULL_TREE;
  alignment_pad->constant = 0;
  alignment_pad->constant = 0;
 
 
  if (boundary > BITS_PER_UNIT)
  if (boundary > BITS_PER_UNIT)
    {
    {
      if (offset_ptr->var)
      if (offset_ptr->var)
        {
        {
          tree sp_offset_tree = ssize_int (sp_offset);
          tree sp_offset_tree = ssize_int (sp_offset);
          tree offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
          tree offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
                                    ARGS_SIZE_TREE (*offset_ptr),
                                    ARGS_SIZE_TREE (*offset_ptr),
                                    sp_offset_tree);
                                    sp_offset_tree);
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
          tree rounded = round_down (offset, boundary / BITS_PER_UNIT);
          tree rounded = round_down (offset, boundary / BITS_PER_UNIT);
#else
#else
          tree rounded = round_up   (offset, boundary / BITS_PER_UNIT);
          tree rounded = round_up   (offset, boundary / BITS_PER_UNIT);
#endif
#endif
 
 
          offset_ptr->var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, rounded, sp_offset_tree);
          offset_ptr->var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, rounded, sp_offset_tree);
          /* ARGS_SIZE_TREE includes constant term.  */
          /* ARGS_SIZE_TREE includes constant term.  */
          offset_ptr->constant = 0;
          offset_ptr->constant = 0;
          if (boundary > PARM_BOUNDARY && boundary > STACK_BOUNDARY)
          if (boundary > PARM_BOUNDARY && boundary > STACK_BOUNDARY)
            alignment_pad->var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, offset_ptr->var,
            alignment_pad->var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, offset_ptr->var,
                                             save_var);
                                             save_var);
        }
        }
      else
      else
        {
        {
          offset_ptr->constant = -sp_offset +
          offset_ptr->constant = -sp_offset +
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
            FLOOR_ROUND (offset_ptr->constant + sp_offset, boundary_in_bytes);
            FLOOR_ROUND (offset_ptr->constant + sp_offset, boundary_in_bytes);
#else
#else
            CEIL_ROUND (offset_ptr->constant + sp_offset, boundary_in_bytes);
            CEIL_ROUND (offset_ptr->constant + sp_offset, boundary_in_bytes);
#endif
#endif
            if (boundary > PARM_BOUNDARY && boundary > STACK_BOUNDARY)
            if (boundary > PARM_BOUNDARY && boundary > STACK_BOUNDARY)
              alignment_pad->constant = offset_ptr->constant - save_constant;
              alignment_pad->constant = offset_ptr->constant - save_constant;
        }
        }
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
static void
static void
pad_below (struct args_size *offset_ptr, enum machine_mode passed_mode, tree sizetree)
pad_below (struct args_size *offset_ptr, enum machine_mode passed_mode, tree sizetree)
{
{
  if (passed_mode != BLKmode)
  if (passed_mode != BLKmode)
    {
    {
      if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (passed_mode) % PARM_BOUNDARY)
      if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (passed_mode) % PARM_BOUNDARY)
        offset_ptr->constant
        offset_ptr->constant
          += (((GET_MODE_BITSIZE (passed_mode) + PARM_BOUNDARY - 1)
          += (((GET_MODE_BITSIZE (passed_mode) + PARM_BOUNDARY - 1)
               / PARM_BOUNDARY * PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)
               / PARM_BOUNDARY * PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)
              - GET_MODE_SIZE (passed_mode));
              - GET_MODE_SIZE (passed_mode));
    }
    }
  else
  else
    {
    {
      if (TREE_CODE (sizetree) != INTEGER_CST
      if (TREE_CODE (sizetree) != INTEGER_CST
          || (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (sizetree) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY)
          || (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (sizetree) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY)
        {
        {
          /* Round the size up to multiple of PARM_BOUNDARY bits.  */
          /* Round the size up to multiple of PARM_BOUNDARY bits.  */
          tree s2 = round_up (sizetree, PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
          tree s2 = round_up (sizetree, PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
          /* Add it in.  */
          /* Add it in.  */
          ADD_PARM_SIZE (*offset_ptr, s2);
          ADD_PARM_SIZE (*offset_ptr, s2);
          SUB_PARM_SIZE (*offset_ptr, sizetree);
          SUB_PARM_SIZE (*offset_ptr, sizetree);
        }
        }
    }
    }
}
}


/* Walk the tree of blocks describing the binding levels within a function
/* Walk the tree of blocks describing the binding levels within a function
   and warn about variables the might be killed by setjmp or vfork.
   and warn about variables the might be killed by setjmp or vfork.
   This is done after calling flow_analysis and before global_alloc
   This is done after calling flow_analysis and before global_alloc
   clobbers the pseudo-regs to hard regs.  */
   clobbers the pseudo-regs to hard regs.  */
 
 
void
void
setjmp_vars_warning (tree block)
setjmp_vars_warning (tree block)
{
{
  tree decl, sub;
  tree decl, sub;
 
 
  for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
  for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
    {
    {
      if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
      if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
          && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl)
          && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl)
          && REG_P (DECL_RTL (decl))
          && REG_P (DECL_RTL (decl))
          && regno_clobbered_at_setjmp (REGNO (DECL_RTL (decl))))
          && regno_clobbered_at_setjmp (REGNO (DECL_RTL (decl))))
        warning (0, "variable %q+D might be clobbered by %<longjmp%>"
        warning (0, "variable %q+D might be clobbered by %<longjmp%>"
                 " or %<vfork%>",
                 " or %<vfork%>",
                 decl);
                 decl);
    }
    }
 
 
  for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block); sub; sub = TREE_CHAIN (sub))
  for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block); sub; sub = TREE_CHAIN (sub))
    setjmp_vars_warning (sub);
    setjmp_vars_warning (sub);
}
}
 
 
/* Do the appropriate part of setjmp_vars_warning
/* Do the appropriate part of setjmp_vars_warning
   but for arguments instead of local variables.  */
   but for arguments instead of local variables.  */
 
 
void
void
setjmp_args_warning (void)
setjmp_args_warning (void)
{
{
  tree decl;
  tree decl;
  for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl);
  for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl);
       decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
       decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
    if (DECL_RTL (decl) != 0
    if (DECL_RTL (decl) != 0
        && REG_P (DECL_RTL (decl))
        && REG_P (DECL_RTL (decl))
        && regno_clobbered_at_setjmp (REGNO (DECL_RTL (decl))))
        && regno_clobbered_at_setjmp (REGNO (DECL_RTL (decl))))
      warning (0, "argument %q+D might be clobbered by %<longjmp%> or %<vfork%>",
      warning (0, "argument %q+D might be clobbered by %<longjmp%> or %<vfork%>",
               decl);
               decl);
}
}
 
 


/* Identify BLOCKs referenced by more than one NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_{BEG,END},
/* Identify BLOCKs referenced by more than one NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_{BEG,END},
   and create duplicate blocks.  */
   and create duplicate blocks.  */
/* ??? Need an option to either create block fragments or to create
/* ??? Need an option to either create block fragments or to create
   abstract origin duplicates of a source block.  It really depends
   abstract origin duplicates of a source block.  It really depends
   on what optimization has been performed.  */
   on what optimization has been performed.  */
 
 
void
void
reorder_blocks (void)
reorder_blocks (void)
{
{
  tree block = DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl);
  tree block = DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl);
  VEC(tree,heap) *block_stack;
  VEC(tree,heap) *block_stack;
 
 
  if (block == NULL_TREE)
  if (block == NULL_TREE)
    return;
    return;
 
 
  block_stack = VEC_alloc (tree, heap, 10);
  block_stack = VEC_alloc (tree, heap, 10);
 
 
  /* Reset the TREE_ASM_WRITTEN bit for all blocks.  */
  /* Reset the TREE_ASM_WRITTEN bit for all blocks.  */
  clear_block_marks (block);
  clear_block_marks (block);
 
 
  /* Prune the old trees away, so that they don't get in the way.  */
  /* Prune the old trees away, so that they don't get in the way.  */
  BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block) = NULL_TREE;
  BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block) = NULL_TREE;
  BLOCK_CHAIN (block) = NULL_TREE;
  BLOCK_CHAIN (block) = NULL_TREE;
 
 
  /* Recreate the block tree from the note nesting.  */
  /* Recreate the block tree from the note nesting.  */
  reorder_blocks_1 (get_insns (), block, &block_stack);
  reorder_blocks_1 (get_insns (), block, &block_stack);
  BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block) = blocks_nreverse (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block));
  BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block) = blocks_nreverse (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block));
 
 
  VEC_free (tree, heap, block_stack);
  VEC_free (tree, heap, block_stack);
}
}
 
 
/* Helper function for reorder_blocks.  Reset TREE_ASM_WRITTEN.  */
/* Helper function for reorder_blocks.  Reset TREE_ASM_WRITTEN.  */
 
 
void
void
clear_block_marks (tree block)
clear_block_marks (tree block)
{
{
  while (block)
  while (block)
    {
    {
      TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block) = 0;
      TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block) = 0;
      clear_block_marks (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block));
      clear_block_marks (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block));
      block = BLOCK_CHAIN (block);
      block = BLOCK_CHAIN (block);
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
static void
static void
reorder_blocks_1 (rtx insns, tree current_block, VEC(tree,heap) **p_block_stack)
reorder_blocks_1 (rtx insns, tree current_block, VEC(tree,heap) **p_block_stack)
{
{
  rtx insn;
  rtx insn;
 
 
  for (insn = insns; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
  for (insn = insns; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
    {
    {
      if (NOTE_P (insn))
      if (NOTE_P (insn))
        {
        {
          if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_BEG)
          if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_BEG)
            {
            {
              tree block = NOTE_BLOCK (insn);
              tree block = NOTE_BLOCK (insn);
              tree origin;
              tree origin;
 
 
              origin = (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block)
              origin = (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block)
                        ? BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block)
                        ? BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block)
                        : block);
                        : block);
 
 
              /* If we have seen this block before, that means it now
              /* If we have seen this block before, that means it now
                 spans multiple address regions.  Create a new fragment.  */
                 spans multiple address regions.  Create a new fragment.  */
              if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block))
              if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block))
                {
                {
                  tree new_block = copy_node (block);
                  tree new_block = copy_node (block);
 
 
                  BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (new_block) = origin;
                  BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (new_block) = origin;
                  BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (new_block)
                  BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (new_block)
                    = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (origin);
                    = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (origin);
                  BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (origin) = new_block;
                  BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (origin) = new_block;
 
 
                  NOTE_BLOCK (insn) = new_block;
                  NOTE_BLOCK (insn) = new_block;
                  block = new_block;
                  block = new_block;
                }
                }
 
 
              BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block) = 0;
              BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block) = 0;
              TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block) = 1;
              TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block) = 1;
              /* When there's only one block for the entire function,
              /* When there's only one block for the entire function,
                 current_block == block and we mustn't do this, it
                 current_block == block and we mustn't do this, it
                 will cause infinite recursion.  */
                 will cause infinite recursion.  */
              if (block != current_block)
              if (block != current_block)
                {
                {
                  if (block != origin)
                  if (block != origin)
                    gcc_assert (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (origin) == current_block);
                    gcc_assert (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (origin) == current_block);
 
 
                  BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block) = current_block;
                  BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block) = current_block;
                  BLOCK_CHAIN (block) = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block);
                  BLOCK_CHAIN (block) = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block);
                  BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block) = block;
                  BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block) = block;
                  current_block = origin;
                  current_block = origin;
                }
                }
              VEC_safe_push (tree, heap, *p_block_stack, block);
              VEC_safe_push (tree, heap, *p_block_stack, block);
            }
            }
          else if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_END)
          else if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_END)
            {
            {
              NOTE_BLOCK (insn) = VEC_pop (tree, *p_block_stack);
              NOTE_BLOCK (insn) = VEC_pop (tree, *p_block_stack);
              BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block)
              BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block)
                = blocks_nreverse (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block));
                = blocks_nreverse (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block));
              current_block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (current_block);
              current_block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (current_block);
            }
            }
        }
        }
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
/* Reverse the order of elements in the chain T of blocks,
/* Reverse the order of elements in the chain T of blocks,
   and return the new head of the chain (old last element).  */
   and return the new head of the chain (old last element).  */
 
 
tree
tree
blocks_nreverse (tree t)
blocks_nreverse (tree t)
{
{
  tree prev = 0, decl, next;
  tree prev = 0, decl, next;
  for (decl = t; decl; decl = next)
  for (decl = t; decl; decl = next)
    {
    {
      next = BLOCK_CHAIN (decl);
      next = BLOCK_CHAIN (decl);
      BLOCK_CHAIN (decl) = prev;
      BLOCK_CHAIN (decl) = prev;
      prev = decl;
      prev = decl;
    }
    }
  return prev;
  return prev;
}
}
 
 
/* Count the subblocks of the list starting with BLOCK.  If VECTOR is
/* Count the subblocks of the list starting with BLOCK.  If VECTOR is
   non-NULL, list them all into VECTOR, in a depth-first preorder
   non-NULL, list them all into VECTOR, in a depth-first preorder
   traversal of the block tree.  Also clear TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in all
   traversal of the block tree.  Also clear TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in all
   blocks.  */
   blocks.  */
 
 
static int
static int
all_blocks (tree block, tree *vector)
all_blocks (tree block, tree *vector)
{
{
  int n_blocks = 0;
  int n_blocks = 0;
 
 
  while (block)
  while (block)
    {
    {
      TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block) = 0;
      TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block) = 0;
 
 
      /* Record this block.  */
      /* Record this block.  */
      if (vector)
      if (vector)
        vector[n_blocks] = block;
        vector[n_blocks] = block;
 
 
      ++n_blocks;
      ++n_blocks;
 
 
      /* Record the subblocks, and their subblocks...  */
      /* Record the subblocks, and their subblocks...  */
      n_blocks += all_blocks (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block),
      n_blocks += all_blocks (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block),
                              vector ? vector + n_blocks : 0);
                              vector ? vector + n_blocks : 0);
      block = BLOCK_CHAIN (block);
      block = BLOCK_CHAIN (block);
    }
    }
 
 
  return n_blocks;
  return n_blocks;
}
}
 
 
/* Return a vector containing all the blocks rooted at BLOCK.  The
/* Return a vector containing all the blocks rooted at BLOCK.  The
   number of elements in the vector is stored in N_BLOCKS_P.  The
   number of elements in the vector is stored in N_BLOCKS_P.  The
   vector is dynamically allocated; it is the caller's responsibility
   vector is dynamically allocated; it is the caller's responsibility
   to call `free' on the pointer returned.  */
   to call `free' on the pointer returned.  */
 
 
static tree *
static tree *
get_block_vector (tree block, int *n_blocks_p)
get_block_vector (tree block, int *n_blocks_p)
{
{
  tree *block_vector;
  tree *block_vector;
 
 
  *n_blocks_p = all_blocks (block, NULL);
  *n_blocks_p = all_blocks (block, NULL);
  block_vector = XNEWVEC (tree, *n_blocks_p);
  block_vector = XNEWVEC (tree, *n_blocks_p);
  all_blocks (block, block_vector);
  all_blocks (block, block_vector);
 
 
  return block_vector;
  return block_vector;
}
}
 
 
static GTY(()) int next_block_index = 2;
static GTY(()) int next_block_index = 2;
 
 
/* Set BLOCK_NUMBER for all the blocks in FN.  */
/* Set BLOCK_NUMBER for all the blocks in FN.  */
 
 
void
void
number_blocks (tree fn)
number_blocks (tree fn)
{
{
  int i;
  int i;
  int n_blocks;
  int n_blocks;
  tree *block_vector;
  tree *block_vector;
 
 
  /* For SDB and XCOFF debugging output, we start numbering the blocks
  /* For SDB and XCOFF debugging output, we start numbering the blocks
     from 1 within each function, rather than keeping a running
     from 1 within each function, rather than keeping a running
     count.  */
     count.  */
#if defined (SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
#if defined (SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
  if (write_symbols == SDB_DEBUG || write_symbols == XCOFF_DEBUG)
  if (write_symbols == SDB_DEBUG || write_symbols == XCOFF_DEBUG)
    next_block_index = 1;
    next_block_index = 1;
#endif
#endif
 
 
  block_vector = get_block_vector (DECL_INITIAL (fn), &n_blocks);
  block_vector = get_block_vector (DECL_INITIAL (fn), &n_blocks);
 
 
  /* The top-level BLOCK isn't numbered at all.  */
  /* The top-level BLOCK isn't numbered at all.  */
  for (i = 1; i < n_blocks; ++i)
  for (i = 1; i < n_blocks; ++i)
    /* We number the blocks from two.  */
    /* We number the blocks from two.  */
    BLOCK_NUMBER (block_vector[i]) = next_block_index++;
    BLOCK_NUMBER (block_vector[i]) = next_block_index++;
 
 
  free (block_vector);
  free (block_vector);
 
 
  return;
  return;
}
}
 
 
/* If VAR is present in a subblock of BLOCK, return the subblock.  */
/* If VAR is present in a subblock of BLOCK, return the subblock.  */
 
 
tree
tree
debug_find_var_in_block_tree (tree var, tree block)
debug_find_var_in_block_tree (tree var, tree block)
{
{
  tree t;
  tree t;
 
 
  for (t = BLOCK_VARS (block); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
  for (t = BLOCK_VARS (block); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
    if (t == var)
    if (t == var)
      return block;
      return block;
 
 
  for (t = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
  for (t = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
    {
    {
      tree ret = debug_find_var_in_block_tree (var, t);
      tree ret = debug_find_var_in_block_tree (var, t);
      if (ret)
      if (ret)
        return ret;
        return ret;
    }
    }
 
 
  return NULL_TREE;
  return NULL_TREE;
}
}


/* Allocate a function structure for FNDECL and set its contents
/* Allocate a function structure for FNDECL and set its contents
   to the defaults.  */
   to the defaults.  */
 
 
void
void
allocate_struct_function (tree fndecl)
allocate_struct_function (tree fndecl)
{
{
  tree result;
  tree result;
  tree fntype = fndecl ? TREE_TYPE (fndecl) : NULL_TREE;
  tree fntype = fndecl ? TREE_TYPE (fndecl) : NULL_TREE;
 
 
  cfun = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct function));
  cfun = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct function));
 
 
  cfun->stack_alignment_needed = STACK_BOUNDARY;
  cfun->stack_alignment_needed = STACK_BOUNDARY;
  cfun->preferred_stack_boundary = STACK_BOUNDARY;
  cfun->preferred_stack_boundary = STACK_BOUNDARY;
 
 
  current_function_funcdef_no = funcdef_no++;
  current_function_funcdef_no = funcdef_no++;
 
 
  cfun->function_frequency = FUNCTION_FREQUENCY_NORMAL;
  cfun->function_frequency = FUNCTION_FREQUENCY_NORMAL;
 
 
  init_eh_for_function ();
  init_eh_for_function ();
 
 
  lang_hooks.function.init (cfun);
  lang_hooks.function.init (cfun);
  if (init_machine_status)
  if (init_machine_status)
    cfun->machine = (*init_machine_status) ();
    cfun->machine = (*init_machine_status) ();
 
 
  if (fndecl == NULL)
  if (fndecl == NULL)
    return;
    return;
 
 
  DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (fndecl) = cfun;
  DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (fndecl) = cfun;
  cfun->decl = fndecl;
  cfun->decl = fndecl;
 
 
  result = DECL_RESULT (fndecl);
  result = DECL_RESULT (fndecl);
  if (aggregate_value_p (result, fndecl))
  if (aggregate_value_p (result, fndecl))
    {
    {
#ifdef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
#ifdef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
      current_function_returns_pcc_struct = 1;
      current_function_returns_pcc_struct = 1;
#endif
#endif
      current_function_returns_struct = 1;
      current_function_returns_struct = 1;
    }
    }
 
 
  current_function_returns_pointer = POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (result));
  current_function_returns_pointer = POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (result));
 
 
  current_function_stdarg
  current_function_stdarg
    = (fntype
    = (fntype
       && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype) != 0
       && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype) != 0
       && (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype)))
       && (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype)))
           != void_type_node));
           != void_type_node));
 
 
  /* Assume all registers in stdarg functions need to be saved.  */
  /* Assume all registers in stdarg functions need to be saved.  */
  cfun->va_list_gpr_size = VA_LIST_MAX_GPR_SIZE;
  cfun->va_list_gpr_size = VA_LIST_MAX_GPR_SIZE;
  cfun->va_list_fpr_size = VA_LIST_MAX_FPR_SIZE;
  cfun->va_list_fpr_size = VA_LIST_MAX_FPR_SIZE;
}
}
 
 
/* Reset cfun, and other non-struct-function variables to defaults as
/* Reset cfun, and other non-struct-function variables to defaults as
   appropriate for emitting rtl at the start of a function.  */
   appropriate for emitting rtl at the start of a function.  */
 
 
static void
static void
prepare_function_start (tree fndecl)
prepare_function_start (tree fndecl)
{
{
  if (fndecl && DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (fndecl))
  if (fndecl && DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (fndecl))
    cfun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (fndecl);
    cfun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (fndecl);
  else
  else
    allocate_struct_function (fndecl);
    allocate_struct_function (fndecl);
  init_emit ();
  init_emit ();
  init_varasm_status (cfun);
  init_varasm_status (cfun);
  init_expr ();
  init_expr ();
 
 
  cse_not_expected = ! optimize;
  cse_not_expected = ! optimize;
 
 
  /* Caller save not needed yet.  */
  /* Caller save not needed yet.  */
  caller_save_needed = 0;
  caller_save_needed = 0;
 
 
  /* We haven't done register allocation yet.  */
  /* We haven't done register allocation yet.  */
  reg_renumber = 0;
  reg_renumber = 0;
 
 
  /* Indicate that we have not instantiated virtual registers yet.  */
  /* Indicate that we have not instantiated virtual registers yet.  */
  virtuals_instantiated = 0;
  virtuals_instantiated = 0;
 
 
  /* Indicate that we want CONCATs now.  */
  /* Indicate that we want CONCATs now.  */
  generating_concat_p = 1;
  generating_concat_p = 1;
 
 
  /* Indicate we have no need of a frame pointer yet.  */
  /* Indicate we have no need of a frame pointer yet.  */
  frame_pointer_needed = 0;
  frame_pointer_needed = 0;
}
}
 
 
/* Initialize the rtl expansion mechanism so that we can do simple things
/* Initialize the rtl expansion mechanism so that we can do simple things
   like generate sequences.  This is used to provide a context during global
   like generate sequences.  This is used to provide a context during global
   initialization of some passes.  */
   initialization of some passes.  */
void
void
init_dummy_function_start (void)
init_dummy_function_start (void)
{
{
  prepare_function_start (NULL);
  prepare_function_start (NULL);
}
}
 
 
/* Generate RTL for the start of the function SUBR (a FUNCTION_DECL tree node)
/* Generate RTL for the start of the function SUBR (a FUNCTION_DECL tree node)
   and initialize static variables for generating RTL for the statements
   and initialize static variables for generating RTL for the statements
   of the function.  */
   of the function.  */
 
 
void
void
init_function_start (tree subr)
init_function_start (tree subr)
{
{
  prepare_function_start (subr);
  prepare_function_start (subr);
 
 
  /* Prevent ever trying to delete the first instruction of a
  /* Prevent ever trying to delete the first instruction of a
     function.  Also tell final how to output a linenum before the
     function.  Also tell final how to output a linenum before the
     function prologue.  Note linenums could be missing, e.g. when
     function prologue.  Note linenums could be missing, e.g. when
     compiling a Java .class file.  */
     compiling a Java .class file.  */
  if (! DECL_IS_BUILTIN (subr))
  if (! DECL_IS_BUILTIN (subr))
    emit_line_note (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (subr));
    emit_line_note (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (subr));
 
 
  /* Make sure first insn is a note even if we don't want linenums.
  /* Make sure first insn is a note even if we don't want linenums.
     This makes sure the first insn will never be deleted.
     This makes sure the first insn will never be deleted.
     Also, final expects a note to appear there.  */
     Also, final expects a note to appear there.  */
  emit_note (NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
  emit_note (NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
 
 
  /* Warn if this value is an aggregate type,
  /* Warn if this value is an aggregate type,
     regardless of which calling convention we are using for it.  */
     regardless of which calling convention we are using for it.  */
  if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr))))
  if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr))))
    warning (OPT_Waggregate_return, "function returns an aggregate");
    warning (OPT_Waggregate_return, "function returns an aggregate");
}
}
 
 
/* Make sure all values used by the optimization passes have sane
/* Make sure all values used by the optimization passes have sane
   defaults.  */
   defaults.  */
unsigned int
unsigned int
init_function_for_compilation (void)
init_function_for_compilation (void)
{
{
  reg_renumber = 0;
  reg_renumber = 0;
 
 
  /* No prologue/epilogue insns yet.  Make sure that these vectors are
  /* No prologue/epilogue insns yet.  Make sure that these vectors are
     empty.  */
     empty.  */
  gcc_assert (VEC_length (int, prologue) == 0);
  gcc_assert (VEC_length (int, prologue) == 0);
  gcc_assert (VEC_length (int, epilogue) == 0);
  gcc_assert (VEC_length (int, epilogue) == 0);
  gcc_assert (VEC_length (int, sibcall_epilogue) == 0);
  gcc_assert (VEC_length (int, sibcall_epilogue) == 0);
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}
 
 
struct tree_opt_pass pass_init_function =
struct tree_opt_pass pass_init_function =
{
{
  NULL,                                 /* name */
  NULL,                                 /* name */
  NULL,                                 /* gate */
  NULL,                                 /* gate */
  init_function_for_compilation,        /* execute */
  init_function_for_compilation,        /* execute */
  NULL,                                 /* sub */
  NULL,                                 /* sub */
  NULL,                                 /* next */
  NULL,                                 /* next */
  0,                                    /* static_pass_number */
  0,                                    /* static_pass_number */
  0,                                    /* tv_id */
  0,                                    /* tv_id */
  0,                                    /* properties_required */
  0,                                    /* properties_required */
  0,                                    /* properties_provided */
  0,                                    /* properties_provided */
  0,                                    /* properties_destroyed */
  0,                                    /* properties_destroyed */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_start */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_start */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_finish */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_finish */
  0                                     /* letter */
  0                                     /* letter */
};
};
 
 
 
 
void
void
expand_main_function (void)
expand_main_function (void)
{
{
#if (defined(INVOKE__main)                              \
#if (defined(INVOKE__main)                              \
     || (!defined(HAS_INIT_SECTION)                     \
     || (!defined(HAS_INIT_SECTION)                     \
         && !defined(INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP)               \
         && !defined(INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP)               \
         && !defined(INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP)))
         && !defined(INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP)))
  emit_library_call (init_one_libfunc (NAME__MAIN), LCT_NORMAL, VOIDmode, 0);
  emit_library_call (init_one_libfunc (NAME__MAIN), LCT_NORMAL, VOIDmode, 0);
#endif
#endif
}
}


/* Expand code to initialize the stack_protect_guard.  This is invoked at
/* Expand code to initialize the stack_protect_guard.  This is invoked at
   the beginning of a function to be protected.  */
   the beginning of a function to be protected.  */
 
 
#ifndef HAVE_stack_protect_set
#ifndef HAVE_stack_protect_set
# define HAVE_stack_protect_set         0
# define HAVE_stack_protect_set         0
# define gen_stack_protect_set(x,y)     (gcc_unreachable (), NULL_RTX)
# define gen_stack_protect_set(x,y)     (gcc_unreachable (), NULL_RTX)
#endif
#endif
 
 
void
void
stack_protect_prologue (void)
stack_protect_prologue (void)
{
{
  tree guard_decl = targetm.stack_protect_guard ();
  tree guard_decl = targetm.stack_protect_guard ();
  rtx x, y;
  rtx x, y;
 
 
  /* Avoid expand_expr here, because we don't want guard_decl pulled
  /* Avoid expand_expr here, because we don't want guard_decl pulled
     into registers unless absolutely necessary.  And we know that
     into registers unless absolutely necessary.  And we know that
     cfun->stack_protect_guard is a local stack slot, so this skips
     cfun->stack_protect_guard is a local stack slot, so this skips
     all the fluff.  */
     all the fluff.  */
  x = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (cfun->stack_protect_guard));
  x = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (cfun->stack_protect_guard));
  y = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (guard_decl));
  y = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (guard_decl));
 
 
  /* Allow the target to copy from Y to X without leaking Y into a
  /* Allow the target to copy from Y to X without leaking Y into a
     register.  */
     register.  */
  if (HAVE_stack_protect_set)
  if (HAVE_stack_protect_set)
    {
    {
      rtx insn = gen_stack_protect_set (x, y);
      rtx insn = gen_stack_protect_set (x, y);
      if (insn)
      if (insn)
        {
        {
          emit_insn (insn);
          emit_insn (insn);
          return;
          return;
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Otherwise do a straight move.  */
  /* Otherwise do a straight move.  */
  emit_move_insn (x, y);
  emit_move_insn (x, y);
}
}
 
 
/* Expand code to verify the stack_protect_guard.  This is invoked at
/* Expand code to verify the stack_protect_guard.  This is invoked at
   the end of a function to be protected.  */
   the end of a function to be protected.  */
 
 
#ifndef HAVE_stack_protect_test
#ifndef HAVE_stack_protect_test
# define HAVE_stack_protect_test                0
# define HAVE_stack_protect_test                0
# define gen_stack_protect_test(x, y, z)        (gcc_unreachable (), NULL_RTX)
# define gen_stack_protect_test(x, y, z)        (gcc_unreachable (), NULL_RTX)
#endif
#endif
 
 
void
void
stack_protect_epilogue (void)
stack_protect_epilogue (void)
{
{
  tree guard_decl = targetm.stack_protect_guard ();
  tree guard_decl = targetm.stack_protect_guard ();
  rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
  rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
  rtx x, y, tmp;
  rtx x, y, tmp;
 
 
  /* Avoid expand_expr here, because we don't want guard_decl pulled
  /* Avoid expand_expr here, because we don't want guard_decl pulled
     into registers unless absolutely necessary.  And we know that
     into registers unless absolutely necessary.  And we know that
     cfun->stack_protect_guard is a local stack slot, so this skips
     cfun->stack_protect_guard is a local stack slot, so this skips
     all the fluff.  */
     all the fluff.  */
  x = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (cfun->stack_protect_guard));
  x = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (cfun->stack_protect_guard));
  y = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (guard_decl));
  y = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (guard_decl));
 
 
  /* Allow the target to compare Y with X without leaking either into
  /* Allow the target to compare Y with X without leaking either into
     a register.  */
     a register.  */
  switch (HAVE_stack_protect_test != 0)
  switch (HAVE_stack_protect_test != 0)
    {
    {
    case 1:
    case 1:
      tmp = gen_stack_protect_test (x, y, label);
      tmp = gen_stack_protect_test (x, y, label);
      if (tmp)
      if (tmp)
        {
        {
          emit_insn (tmp);
          emit_insn (tmp);
          break;
          break;
        }
        }
      /* FALLTHRU */
      /* FALLTHRU */
 
 
    default:
    default:
      emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (x, y, EQ, NULL_RTX, ptr_mode, 1, label);
      emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (x, y, EQ, NULL_RTX, ptr_mode, 1, label);
      break;
      break;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* The noreturn predictor has been moved to the tree level.  The rtl-level
  /* The noreturn predictor has been moved to the tree level.  The rtl-level
     predictors estimate this branch about 20%, which isn't enough to get
     predictors estimate this branch about 20%, which isn't enough to get
     things moved out of line.  Since this is the only extant case of adding
     things moved out of line.  Since this is the only extant case of adding
     a noreturn function at the rtl level, it doesn't seem worth doing ought
     a noreturn function at the rtl level, it doesn't seem worth doing ought
     except adding the prediction by hand.  */
     except adding the prediction by hand.  */
  tmp = get_last_insn ();
  tmp = get_last_insn ();
  if (JUMP_P (tmp))
  if (JUMP_P (tmp))
    predict_insn_def (tmp, PRED_NORETURN, TAKEN);
    predict_insn_def (tmp, PRED_NORETURN, TAKEN);
 
 
  expand_expr_stmt (targetm.stack_protect_fail ());
  expand_expr_stmt (targetm.stack_protect_fail ());
  emit_label (label);
  emit_label (label);
}
}


/* Start the RTL for a new function, and set variables used for
/* Start the RTL for a new function, and set variables used for
   emitting RTL.
   emitting RTL.
   SUBR is the FUNCTION_DECL node.
   SUBR is the FUNCTION_DECL node.
   PARMS_HAVE_CLEANUPS is nonzero if there are cleanups associated with
   PARMS_HAVE_CLEANUPS is nonzero if there are cleanups associated with
   the function's parameters, which must be run at any return statement.  */
   the function's parameters, which must be run at any return statement.  */
 
 
void
void
expand_function_start (tree subr)
expand_function_start (tree subr)
{
{
  /* Make sure volatile mem refs aren't considered
  /* Make sure volatile mem refs aren't considered
     valid operands of arithmetic insns.  */
     valid operands of arithmetic insns.  */
  init_recog_no_volatile ();
  init_recog_no_volatile ();
 
 
  current_function_profile
  current_function_profile
    = (profile_flag
    = (profile_flag
       && ! DECL_NO_INSTRUMENT_FUNCTION_ENTRY_EXIT (subr));
       && ! DECL_NO_INSTRUMENT_FUNCTION_ENTRY_EXIT (subr));
 
 
  current_function_limit_stack
  current_function_limit_stack
    = (stack_limit_rtx != NULL_RTX && ! DECL_NO_LIMIT_STACK (subr));
    = (stack_limit_rtx != NULL_RTX && ! DECL_NO_LIMIT_STACK (subr));
 
 
  /* Make the label for return statements to jump to.  Do not special
  /* Make the label for return statements to jump to.  Do not special
     case machines with special return instructions -- they will be
     case machines with special return instructions -- they will be
     handled later during jump, ifcvt, or epilogue creation.  */
     handled later during jump, ifcvt, or epilogue creation.  */
  return_label = gen_label_rtx ();
  return_label = gen_label_rtx ();
 
 
  /* Initialize rtx used to return the value.  */
  /* Initialize rtx used to return the value.  */
  /* Do this before assign_parms so that we copy the struct value address
  /* Do this before assign_parms so that we copy the struct value address
     before any library calls that assign parms might generate.  */
     before any library calls that assign parms might generate.  */
 
 
  /* Decide whether to return the value in memory or in a register.  */
  /* Decide whether to return the value in memory or in a register.  */
  if (aggregate_value_p (DECL_RESULT (subr), subr))
  if (aggregate_value_p (DECL_RESULT (subr), subr))
    {
    {
      /* Returning something that won't go in a register.  */
      /* Returning something that won't go in a register.  */
      rtx value_address = 0;
      rtx value_address = 0;
 
 
#ifdef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
#ifdef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
      if (current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
      if (current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
        {
        {
          int size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr)));
          int size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr)));
          value_address = assemble_static_space (size);
          value_address = assemble_static_space (size);
        }
        }
      else
      else
#endif
#endif
        {
        {
          rtx sv = targetm.calls.struct_value_rtx (TREE_TYPE (subr), 2);
          rtx sv = targetm.calls.struct_value_rtx (TREE_TYPE (subr), 2);
          /* Expect to be passed the address of a place to store the value.
          /* Expect to be passed the address of a place to store the value.
             If it is passed as an argument, assign_parms will take care of
             If it is passed as an argument, assign_parms will take care of
             it.  */
             it.  */
          if (sv)
          if (sv)
            {
            {
              value_address = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
              value_address = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
              emit_move_insn (value_address, sv);
              emit_move_insn (value_address, sv);
            }
            }
        }
        }
      if (value_address)
      if (value_address)
        {
        {
          rtx x = value_address;
          rtx x = value_address;
          if (!DECL_BY_REFERENCE (DECL_RESULT (subr)))
          if (!DECL_BY_REFERENCE (DECL_RESULT (subr)))
            {
            {
              x = gen_rtx_MEM (DECL_MODE (DECL_RESULT (subr)), x);
              x = gen_rtx_MEM (DECL_MODE (DECL_RESULT (subr)), x);
              set_mem_attributes (x, DECL_RESULT (subr), 1);
              set_mem_attributes (x, DECL_RESULT (subr), 1);
            }
            }
          SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), x);
          SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), x);
        }
        }
    }
    }
  else if (DECL_MODE (DECL_RESULT (subr)) == VOIDmode)
  else if (DECL_MODE (DECL_RESULT (subr)) == VOIDmode)
    /* If return mode is void, this decl rtl should not be used.  */
    /* If return mode is void, this decl rtl should not be used.  */
    SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), NULL_RTX);
    SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), NULL_RTX);
  else
  else
    {
    {
      /* Compute the return values into a pseudo reg, which we will copy
      /* Compute the return values into a pseudo reg, which we will copy
         into the true return register after the cleanups are done.  */
         into the true return register after the cleanups are done.  */
      tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr));
      tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr));
      if (TYPE_MODE (return_type) != BLKmode
      if (TYPE_MODE (return_type) != BLKmode
          && targetm.calls.return_in_msb (return_type))
          && targetm.calls.return_in_msb (return_type))
        /* expand_function_end will insert the appropriate padding in
        /* expand_function_end will insert the appropriate padding in
           this case.  Use the return value's natural (unpadded) mode
           this case.  Use the return value's natural (unpadded) mode
           within the function proper.  */
           within the function proper.  */
        SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr),
        SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr),
                      gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (return_type)));
                      gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (return_type)));
      else
      else
        {
        {
          /* In order to figure out what mode to use for the pseudo, we
          /* In order to figure out what mode to use for the pseudo, we
             figure out what the mode of the eventual return register will
             figure out what the mode of the eventual return register will
             actually be, and use that.  */
             actually be, and use that.  */
          rtx hard_reg = hard_function_value (return_type, subr, 0, 1);
          rtx hard_reg = hard_function_value (return_type, subr, 0, 1);
 
 
          /* Structures that are returned in registers are not
          /* Structures that are returned in registers are not
             aggregate_value_p, so we may see a PARALLEL or a REG.  */
             aggregate_value_p, so we may see a PARALLEL or a REG.  */
          if (REG_P (hard_reg))
          if (REG_P (hard_reg))
            SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr),
            SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr),
                          gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (hard_reg)));
                          gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (hard_reg)));
          else
          else
            {
            {
              gcc_assert (GET_CODE (hard_reg) == PARALLEL);
              gcc_assert (GET_CODE (hard_reg) == PARALLEL);
              SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), gen_group_rtx (hard_reg));
              SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), gen_group_rtx (hard_reg));
            }
            }
        }
        }
 
 
      /* Set DECL_REGISTER flag so that expand_function_end will copy the
      /* Set DECL_REGISTER flag so that expand_function_end will copy the
         result to the real return register(s).  */
         result to the real return register(s).  */
      DECL_REGISTER (DECL_RESULT (subr)) = 1;
      DECL_REGISTER (DECL_RESULT (subr)) = 1;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Initialize rtx for parameters and local variables.
  /* Initialize rtx for parameters and local variables.
     In some cases this requires emitting insns.  */
     In some cases this requires emitting insns.  */
  assign_parms (subr);
  assign_parms (subr);
 
 
  /* If function gets a static chain arg, store it.  */
  /* If function gets a static chain arg, store it.  */
  if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
  if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
    {
    {
      tree parm = cfun->static_chain_decl;
      tree parm = cfun->static_chain_decl;
      rtx local = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
      rtx local = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
 
 
      set_decl_incoming_rtl (parm, static_chain_incoming_rtx);
      set_decl_incoming_rtl (parm, static_chain_incoming_rtx);
      SET_DECL_RTL (parm, local);
      SET_DECL_RTL (parm, local);
      mark_reg_pointer (local, TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm))));
      mark_reg_pointer (local, TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm))));
 
 
      emit_move_insn (local, static_chain_incoming_rtx);
      emit_move_insn (local, static_chain_incoming_rtx);
    }
    }
 
 
  /* If the function receives a non-local goto, then store the
  /* If the function receives a non-local goto, then store the
     bits we need to restore the frame pointer.  */
     bits we need to restore the frame pointer.  */
  if (cfun->nonlocal_goto_save_area)
  if (cfun->nonlocal_goto_save_area)
    {
    {
      tree t_save;
      tree t_save;
      rtx r_save;
      rtx r_save;
 
 
      /* ??? We need to do this save early.  Unfortunately here is
      /* ??? We need to do this save early.  Unfortunately here is
         before the frame variable gets declared.  Help out...  */
         before the frame variable gets declared.  Help out...  */
      expand_var (TREE_OPERAND (cfun->nonlocal_goto_save_area, 0));
      expand_var (TREE_OPERAND (cfun->nonlocal_goto_save_area, 0));
 
 
      t_save = build4 (ARRAY_REF, ptr_type_node,
      t_save = build4 (ARRAY_REF, ptr_type_node,
                       cfun->nonlocal_goto_save_area,
                       cfun->nonlocal_goto_save_area,
                       integer_zero_node, NULL_TREE, NULL_TREE);
                       integer_zero_node, NULL_TREE, NULL_TREE);
      r_save = expand_expr (t_save, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
      r_save = expand_expr (t_save, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
      r_save = convert_memory_address (Pmode, r_save);
      r_save = convert_memory_address (Pmode, r_save);
 
 
      emit_move_insn (r_save, virtual_stack_vars_rtx);
      emit_move_insn (r_save, virtual_stack_vars_rtx);
      update_nonlocal_goto_save_area ();
      update_nonlocal_goto_save_area ();
    }
    }
 
 
  /* The following was moved from init_function_start.
  /* The following was moved from init_function_start.
     The move is supposed to make sdb output more accurate.  */
     The move is supposed to make sdb output more accurate.  */
  /* Indicate the beginning of the function body,
  /* Indicate the beginning of the function body,
     as opposed to parm setup.  */
     as opposed to parm setup.  */
  emit_note (NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG);
  emit_note (NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG);
 
 
  gcc_assert (NOTE_P (get_last_insn ()));
  gcc_assert (NOTE_P (get_last_insn ()));
 
 
  parm_birth_insn = get_last_insn ();
  parm_birth_insn = get_last_insn ();
 
 
  if (current_function_profile)
  if (current_function_profile)
    {
    {
#ifdef PROFILE_HOOK
#ifdef PROFILE_HOOK
      PROFILE_HOOK (current_function_funcdef_no);
      PROFILE_HOOK (current_function_funcdef_no);
#endif
#endif
    }
    }
 
 
  /* After the display initializations is where the stack checking
  /* After the display initializations is where the stack checking
     probe should go.  */
     probe should go.  */
  if(flag_stack_check)
  if(flag_stack_check)
    stack_check_probe_note = emit_note (NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
    stack_check_probe_note = emit_note (NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
 
 
  /* Make sure there is a line number after the function entry setup code.  */
  /* Make sure there is a line number after the function entry setup code.  */
  force_next_line_note ();
  force_next_line_note ();
}
}


/* Undo the effects of init_dummy_function_start.  */
/* Undo the effects of init_dummy_function_start.  */
void
void
expand_dummy_function_end (void)
expand_dummy_function_end (void)
{
{
  /* End any sequences that failed to be closed due to syntax errors.  */
  /* End any sequences that failed to be closed due to syntax errors.  */
  while (in_sequence_p ())
  while (in_sequence_p ())
    end_sequence ();
    end_sequence ();
 
 
  /* Outside function body, can't compute type's actual size
  /* Outside function body, can't compute type's actual size
     until next function's body starts.  */
     until next function's body starts.  */
 
 
  free_after_parsing (cfun);
  free_after_parsing (cfun);
  free_after_compilation (cfun);
  free_after_compilation (cfun);
  cfun = 0;
  cfun = 0;
}
}
 
 
/* Call DOIT for each hard register used as a return value from
/* Call DOIT for each hard register used as a return value from
   the current function.  */
   the current function.  */
 
 
void
void
diddle_return_value (void (*doit) (rtx, void *), void *arg)
diddle_return_value (void (*doit) (rtx, void *), void *arg)
{
{
  rtx outgoing = current_function_return_rtx;
  rtx outgoing = current_function_return_rtx;
 
 
  if (! outgoing)
  if (! outgoing)
    return;
    return;
 
 
  if (REG_P (outgoing))
  if (REG_P (outgoing))
    (*doit) (outgoing, arg);
    (*doit) (outgoing, arg);
  else if (GET_CODE (outgoing) == PARALLEL)
  else if (GET_CODE (outgoing) == PARALLEL)
    {
    {
      int i;
      int i;
 
 
      for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (outgoing, 0); i++)
      for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (outgoing, 0); i++)
        {
        {
          rtx x = XEXP (XVECEXP (outgoing, 0, i), 0);
          rtx x = XEXP (XVECEXP (outgoing, 0, i), 0);
 
 
          if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
          if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
            (*doit) (x, arg);
            (*doit) (x, arg);
        }
        }
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
static void
static void
do_clobber_return_reg (rtx reg, void *arg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
do_clobber_return_reg (rtx reg, void *arg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
{
{
  emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, reg));
  emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, reg));
}
}
 
 
void
void
clobber_return_register (void)
clobber_return_register (void)
{
{
  diddle_return_value (do_clobber_return_reg, NULL);
  diddle_return_value (do_clobber_return_reg, NULL);
 
 
  /* In case we do use pseudo to return value, clobber it too.  */
  /* In case we do use pseudo to return value, clobber it too.  */
  if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
  if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
    {
    {
      tree decl_result = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
      tree decl_result = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
      rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (decl_result);
      rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (decl_result);
      if (REG_P (decl_rtl) && REGNO (decl_rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
      if (REG_P (decl_rtl) && REGNO (decl_rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
        {
        {
          do_clobber_return_reg (decl_rtl, NULL);
          do_clobber_return_reg (decl_rtl, NULL);
        }
        }
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
static void
static void
do_use_return_reg (rtx reg, void *arg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
do_use_return_reg (rtx reg, void *arg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
{
{
  emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg));
  emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg));
}
}
 
 
static void
static void
use_return_register (void)
use_return_register (void)
{
{
  diddle_return_value (do_use_return_reg, NULL);
  diddle_return_value (do_use_return_reg, NULL);
}
}
 
 
/* Possibly warn about unused parameters.  */
/* Possibly warn about unused parameters.  */
void
void
do_warn_unused_parameter (tree fn)
do_warn_unused_parameter (tree fn)
{
{
  tree decl;
  tree decl;
 
 
  for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fn);
  for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fn);
       decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
       decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
    if (!TREE_USED (decl) && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
    if (!TREE_USED (decl) && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
        && DECL_NAME (decl) && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
        && DECL_NAME (decl) && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
      warning (OPT_Wunused_parameter, "unused parameter %q+D", decl);
      warning (OPT_Wunused_parameter, "unused parameter %q+D", decl);
}
}
 
 
static GTY(()) rtx initial_trampoline;
static GTY(()) rtx initial_trampoline;
 
 
/* Generate RTL for the end of the current function.  */
/* Generate RTL for the end of the current function.  */
 
 
void
void
expand_function_end (void)
expand_function_end (void)
{
{
  rtx clobber_after;
  rtx clobber_after;
 
 
  /* If arg_pointer_save_area was referenced only from a nested
  /* If arg_pointer_save_area was referenced only from a nested
     function, we will not have initialized it yet.  Do that now.  */
     function, we will not have initialized it yet.  Do that now.  */
  if (arg_pointer_save_area && ! cfun->arg_pointer_save_area_init)
  if (arg_pointer_save_area && ! cfun->arg_pointer_save_area_init)
    get_arg_pointer_save_area (cfun);
    get_arg_pointer_save_area (cfun);
 
 
  /* If we are doing stack checking and this function makes calls,
  /* If we are doing stack checking and this function makes calls,
     do a stack probe at the start of the function to ensure we have enough
     do a stack probe at the start of the function to ensure we have enough
     space for another stack frame.  */
     space for another stack frame.  */
  if (flag_stack_check && ! STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN)
  if (flag_stack_check && ! STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN)
    {
    {
      rtx insn, seq;
      rtx insn, seq;
 
 
      for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
      for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
        if (CALL_P (insn))
        if (CALL_P (insn))
          {
          {
            start_sequence ();
            start_sequence ();
            probe_stack_range (STACK_CHECK_PROTECT,
            probe_stack_range (STACK_CHECK_PROTECT,
                               GEN_INT (STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE));
                               GEN_INT (STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE));
            seq = get_insns ();
            seq = get_insns ();
            end_sequence ();
            end_sequence ();
            emit_insn_before (seq, stack_check_probe_note);
            emit_insn_before (seq, stack_check_probe_note);
            break;
            break;
          }
          }
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Possibly warn about unused parameters.
  /* Possibly warn about unused parameters.
     When frontend does unit-at-a-time, the warning is already
     When frontend does unit-at-a-time, the warning is already
     issued at finalization time.  */
     issued at finalization time.  */
  if (warn_unused_parameter
  if (warn_unused_parameter
      && !lang_hooks.callgraph.expand_function)
      && !lang_hooks.callgraph.expand_function)
    do_warn_unused_parameter (current_function_decl);
    do_warn_unused_parameter (current_function_decl);
 
 
  /* End any sequences that failed to be closed due to syntax errors.  */
  /* End any sequences that failed to be closed due to syntax errors.  */
  while (in_sequence_p ())
  while (in_sequence_p ())
    end_sequence ();
    end_sequence ();
 
 
  clear_pending_stack_adjust ();
  clear_pending_stack_adjust ();
  do_pending_stack_adjust ();
  do_pending_stack_adjust ();
 
 
  /* Mark the end of the function body.
  /* Mark the end of the function body.
     If control reaches this insn, the function can drop through
     If control reaches this insn, the function can drop through
     without returning a value.  */
     without returning a value.  */
  emit_note (NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_END);
  emit_note (NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_END);
 
 
  /* Must mark the last line number note in the function, so that the test
  /* Must mark the last line number note in the function, so that the test
     coverage code can avoid counting the last line twice.  This just tells
     coverage code can avoid counting the last line twice.  This just tells
     the code to ignore the immediately following line note, since there
     the code to ignore the immediately following line note, since there
     already exists a copy of this note somewhere above.  This line number
     already exists a copy of this note somewhere above.  This line number
     note is still needed for debugging though, so we can't delete it.  */
     note is still needed for debugging though, so we can't delete it.  */
  if (flag_test_coverage)
  if (flag_test_coverage)
    emit_note (NOTE_INSN_REPEATED_LINE_NUMBER);
    emit_note (NOTE_INSN_REPEATED_LINE_NUMBER);
 
 
  /* Output a linenumber for the end of the function.
  /* Output a linenumber for the end of the function.
     SDB depends on this.  */
     SDB depends on this.  */
  force_next_line_note ();
  force_next_line_note ();
  emit_line_note (input_location);
  emit_line_note (input_location);
 
 
  /* Before the return label (if any), clobber the return
  /* Before the return label (if any), clobber the return
     registers so that they are not propagated live to the rest of
     registers so that they are not propagated live to the rest of
     the function.  This can only happen with functions that drop
     the function.  This can only happen with functions that drop
     through; if there had been a return statement, there would
     through; if there had been a return statement, there would
     have either been a return rtx, or a jump to the return label.
     have either been a return rtx, or a jump to the return label.
 
 
     We delay actual code generation after the current_function_value_rtx
     We delay actual code generation after the current_function_value_rtx
     is computed.  */
     is computed.  */
  clobber_after = get_last_insn ();
  clobber_after = get_last_insn ();
 
 
  /* Output the label for the actual return from the function.  */
  /* Output the label for the actual return from the function.  */
  emit_label (return_label);
  emit_label (return_label);
 
 
  if (USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
  if (USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
    {
    {
      /* Let except.c know where it should emit the call to unregister
      /* Let except.c know where it should emit the call to unregister
         the function context for sjlj exceptions.  */
         the function context for sjlj exceptions.  */
      if (flag_exceptions)
      if (flag_exceptions)
        sjlj_emit_function_exit_after (get_last_insn ());
        sjlj_emit_function_exit_after (get_last_insn ());
    }
    }
  else
  else
    {
    {
      /* @@@ This is a kludge.  We want to ensure that instructions that
      /* @@@ This is a kludge.  We want to ensure that instructions that
         may trap are not moved into the epilogue by scheduling, because
         may trap are not moved into the epilogue by scheduling, because
         we don't always emit unwind information for the epilogue.
         we don't always emit unwind information for the epilogue.
         However, not all machine descriptions define a blockage insn, so
         However, not all machine descriptions define a blockage insn, so
         emit an ASM_INPUT to act as one.  */
         emit an ASM_INPUT to act as one.  */
      if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
      if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
        emit_insn (gen_rtx_ASM_INPUT (VOIDmode, ""));
        emit_insn (gen_rtx_ASM_INPUT (VOIDmode, ""));
    }
    }
 
 
  /* If this is an implementation of throw, do what's necessary to
  /* If this is an implementation of throw, do what's necessary to
     communicate between __builtin_eh_return and the epilogue.  */
     communicate between __builtin_eh_return and the epilogue.  */
  expand_eh_return ();
  expand_eh_return ();
 
 
  /* If scalar return value was computed in a pseudo-reg, or was a named
  /* If scalar return value was computed in a pseudo-reg, or was a named
     return value that got dumped to the stack, copy that to the hard
     return value that got dumped to the stack, copy that to the hard
     return register.  */
     return register.  */
  if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
  if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
    {
    {
      tree decl_result = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
      tree decl_result = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
      rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (decl_result);
      rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (decl_result);
 
 
      if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
      if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
          ? REGNO (decl_rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
          ? REGNO (decl_rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
          : DECL_REGISTER (decl_result))
          : DECL_REGISTER (decl_result))
        {
        {
          rtx real_decl_rtl = current_function_return_rtx;
          rtx real_decl_rtl = current_function_return_rtx;
 
 
          /* This should be set in assign_parms.  */
          /* This should be set in assign_parms.  */
          gcc_assert (REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (real_decl_rtl));
          gcc_assert (REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (real_decl_rtl));
 
 
          /* If this is a BLKmode structure being returned in registers,
          /* If this is a BLKmode structure being returned in registers,
             then use the mode computed in expand_return.  Note that if
             then use the mode computed in expand_return.  Note that if
             decl_rtl is memory, then its mode may have been changed,
             decl_rtl is memory, then its mode may have been changed,
             but that current_function_return_rtx has not.  */
             but that current_function_return_rtx has not.  */
          if (GET_MODE (real_decl_rtl) == BLKmode)
          if (GET_MODE (real_decl_rtl) == BLKmode)
            PUT_MODE (real_decl_rtl, GET_MODE (decl_rtl));
            PUT_MODE (real_decl_rtl, GET_MODE (decl_rtl));
 
 
          /* If a non-BLKmode return value should be padded at the least
          /* If a non-BLKmode return value should be padded at the least
             significant end of the register, shift it left by the appropriate
             significant end of the register, shift it left by the appropriate
             amount.  BLKmode results are handled using the group load/store
             amount.  BLKmode results are handled using the group load/store
             machinery.  */
             machinery.  */
          if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl_result)) != BLKmode
          if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl_result)) != BLKmode
              && targetm.calls.return_in_msb (TREE_TYPE (decl_result)))
              && targetm.calls.return_in_msb (TREE_TYPE (decl_result)))
            {
            {
              emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (decl_rtl),
              emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (decl_rtl),
                                           REGNO (real_decl_rtl)),
                                           REGNO (real_decl_rtl)),
                              decl_rtl);
                              decl_rtl);
              shift_return_value (GET_MODE (decl_rtl), true, real_decl_rtl);
              shift_return_value (GET_MODE (decl_rtl), true, real_decl_rtl);
            }
            }
          /* If a named return value dumped decl_return to memory, then
          /* If a named return value dumped decl_return to memory, then
             we may need to re-do the PROMOTE_MODE signed/unsigned
             we may need to re-do the PROMOTE_MODE signed/unsigned
             extension.  */
             extension.  */
          else if (GET_MODE (real_decl_rtl) != GET_MODE (decl_rtl))
          else if (GET_MODE (real_decl_rtl) != GET_MODE (decl_rtl))
            {
            {
              int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl_result));
              int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl_result));
 
 
              if (targetm.calls.promote_function_return (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)))
              if (targetm.calls.promote_function_return (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)))
                promote_mode (TREE_TYPE (decl_result), GET_MODE (decl_rtl),
                promote_mode (TREE_TYPE (decl_result), GET_MODE (decl_rtl),
                              &unsignedp, 1);
                              &unsignedp, 1);
 
 
              convert_move (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl, unsignedp);
              convert_move (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl, unsignedp);
            }
            }
          else if (GET_CODE (real_decl_rtl) == PARALLEL)
          else if (GET_CODE (real_decl_rtl) == PARALLEL)
            {
            {
              /* If expand_function_start has created a PARALLEL for decl_rtl,
              /* If expand_function_start has created a PARALLEL for decl_rtl,
                 move the result to the real return registers.  Otherwise, do
                 move the result to the real return registers.  Otherwise, do
                 a group load from decl_rtl for a named return.  */
                 a group load from decl_rtl for a named return.  */
              if (GET_CODE (decl_rtl) == PARALLEL)
              if (GET_CODE (decl_rtl) == PARALLEL)
                emit_group_move (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl);
                emit_group_move (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl);
              else
              else
                emit_group_load (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl,
                emit_group_load (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl,
                                 TREE_TYPE (decl_result),
                                 TREE_TYPE (decl_result),
                                 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl_result)));
                                 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl_result)));
            }
            }
          /* In the case of complex integer modes smaller than a word, we'll
          /* In the case of complex integer modes smaller than a word, we'll
             need to generate some non-trivial bitfield insertions.  Do that
             need to generate some non-trivial bitfield insertions.  Do that
             on a pseudo and not the hard register.  */
             on a pseudo and not the hard register.  */
          else if (GET_CODE (decl_rtl) == CONCAT
          else if (GET_CODE (decl_rtl) == CONCAT
                   && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (decl_rtl)) == MODE_COMPLEX_INT
                   && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (decl_rtl)) == MODE_COMPLEX_INT
                   && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (decl_rtl)) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
                   && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (decl_rtl)) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
            {
            {
              int old_generating_concat_p;
              int old_generating_concat_p;
              rtx tmp;
              rtx tmp;
 
 
              old_generating_concat_p = generating_concat_p;
              old_generating_concat_p = generating_concat_p;
              generating_concat_p = 0;
              generating_concat_p = 0;
              tmp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (decl_rtl));
              tmp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (decl_rtl));
              generating_concat_p = old_generating_concat_p;
              generating_concat_p = old_generating_concat_p;
 
 
              emit_move_insn (tmp, decl_rtl);
              emit_move_insn (tmp, decl_rtl);
              emit_move_insn (real_decl_rtl, tmp);
              emit_move_insn (real_decl_rtl, tmp);
            }
            }
          else
          else
            emit_move_insn (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl);
            emit_move_insn (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl);
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  /* If returning a structure, arrange to return the address of the value
  /* If returning a structure, arrange to return the address of the value
     in a place where debuggers expect to find it.
     in a place where debuggers expect to find it.
 
 
     If returning a structure PCC style,
     If returning a structure PCC style,
     the caller also depends on this value.
     the caller also depends on this value.
     And current_function_returns_pcc_struct is not necessarily set.  */
     And current_function_returns_pcc_struct is not necessarily set.  */
  if (current_function_returns_struct
  if (current_function_returns_struct
      || current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
      || current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
    {
    {
      rtx value_address = DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl));
      rtx value_address = DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl));
      tree type = TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl));
      tree type = TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl));
      rtx outgoing;
      rtx outgoing;
 
 
      if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
      if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
        type = TREE_TYPE (type);
        type = TREE_TYPE (type);
      else
      else
        value_address = XEXP (value_address, 0);
        value_address = XEXP (value_address, 0);
 
 
      outgoing = targetm.calls.function_value (build_pointer_type (type),
      outgoing = targetm.calls.function_value (build_pointer_type (type),
                                               current_function_decl, true);
                                               current_function_decl, true);
 
 
      /* Mark this as a function return value so integrate will delete the
      /* Mark this as a function return value so integrate will delete the
         assignment and USE below when inlining this function.  */
         assignment and USE below when inlining this function.  */
      REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (outgoing) = 1;
      REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (outgoing) = 1;
 
 
      /* The address may be ptr_mode and OUTGOING may be Pmode.  */
      /* The address may be ptr_mode and OUTGOING may be Pmode.  */
      value_address = convert_memory_address (GET_MODE (outgoing),
      value_address = convert_memory_address (GET_MODE (outgoing),
                                              value_address);
                                              value_address);
 
 
      emit_move_insn (outgoing, value_address);
      emit_move_insn (outgoing, value_address);
 
 
      /* Show return register used to hold result (in this case the address
      /* Show return register used to hold result (in this case the address
         of the result.  */
         of the result.  */
      current_function_return_rtx = outgoing;
      current_function_return_rtx = outgoing;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Emit the actual code to clobber return register.  */
  /* Emit the actual code to clobber return register.  */
  {
  {
    rtx seq;
    rtx seq;
 
 
    start_sequence ();
    start_sequence ();
    clobber_return_register ();
    clobber_return_register ();
    expand_naked_return ();
    expand_naked_return ();
    seq = get_insns ();
    seq = get_insns ();
    end_sequence ();
    end_sequence ();
 
 
    emit_insn_after (seq, clobber_after);
    emit_insn_after (seq, clobber_after);
  }
  }
 
 
  /* Output the label for the naked return from the function.  */
  /* Output the label for the naked return from the function.  */
  emit_label (naked_return_label);
  emit_label (naked_return_label);
 
 
  /* If stack protection is enabled for this function, check the guard.  */
  /* If stack protection is enabled for this function, check the guard.  */
  if (cfun->stack_protect_guard)
  if (cfun->stack_protect_guard)
    stack_protect_epilogue ();
    stack_protect_epilogue ();
 
 
  /* If we had calls to alloca, and this machine needs
  /* If we had calls to alloca, and this machine needs
     an accurate stack pointer to exit the function,
     an accurate stack pointer to exit the function,
     insert some code to save and restore the stack pointer.  */
     insert some code to save and restore the stack pointer.  */
  if (! EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
  if (! EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
      && current_function_calls_alloca)
      && current_function_calls_alloca)
    {
    {
      rtx tem = 0;
      rtx tem = 0;
 
 
      emit_stack_save (SAVE_FUNCTION, &tem, parm_birth_insn);
      emit_stack_save (SAVE_FUNCTION, &tem, parm_birth_insn);
      emit_stack_restore (SAVE_FUNCTION, tem, NULL_RTX);
      emit_stack_restore (SAVE_FUNCTION, tem, NULL_RTX);
    }
    }
 
 
  /* ??? This should no longer be necessary since stupid is no longer with
  /* ??? This should no longer be necessary since stupid is no longer with
     us, but there are some parts of the compiler (eg reload_combine, and
     us, but there are some parts of the compiler (eg reload_combine, and
     sh mach_dep_reorg) that still try and compute their own lifetime info
     sh mach_dep_reorg) that still try and compute their own lifetime info
     instead of using the general framework.  */
     instead of using the general framework.  */
  use_return_register ();
  use_return_register ();
}
}
 
 
rtx
rtx
get_arg_pointer_save_area (struct function *f)
get_arg_pointer_save_area (struct function *f)
{
{
  rtx ret = f->x_arg_pointer_save_area;
  rtx ret = f->x_arg_pointer_save_area;
 
 
  if (! ret)
  if (! ret)
    {
    {
      ret = assign_stack_local_1 (Pmode, GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode), 0, f);
      ret = assign_stack_local_1 (Pmode, GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode), 0, f);
      f->x_arg_pointer_save_area = ret;
      f->x_arg_pointer_save_area = ret;
    }
    }
 
 
  if (f == cfun && ! f->arg_pointer_save_area_init)
  if (f == cfun && ! f->arg_pointer_save_area_init)
    {
    {
      rtx seq;
      rtx seq;
 
 
      /* Save the arg pointer at the beginning of the function.  The
      /* Save the arg pointer at the beginning of the function.  The
         generated stack slot may not be a valid memory address, so we
         generated stack slot may not be a valid memory address, so we
         have to check it and fix it if necessary.  */
         have to check it and fix it if necessary.  */
      start_sequence ();
      start_sequence ();
      emit_move_insn (validize_mem (ret), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
      emit_move_insn (validize_mem (ret), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
      seq = get_insns ();
      seq = get_insns ();
      end_sequence ();
      end_sequence ();
 
 
      push_topmost_sequence ();
      push_topmost_sequence ();
      emit_insn_after (seq, entry_of_function ());
      emit_insn_after (seq, entry_of_function ());
      pop_topmost_sequence ();
      pop_topmost_sequence ();
    }
    }
 
 
  return ret;
  return ret;
}
}


/* Extend a vector that records the INSN_UIDs of INSNS
/* Extend a vector that records the INSN_UIDs of INSNS
   (a list of one or more insns).  */
   (a list of one or more insns).  */
 
 
static void
static void
record_insns (rtx insns, VEC(int,heap) **vecp)
record_insns (rtx insns, VEC(int,heap) **vecp)
{
{
  rtx tmp;
  rtx tmp;
 
 
  for (tmp = insns; tmp != NULL_RTX; tmp = NEXT_INSN (tmp))
  for (tmp = insns; tmp != NULL_RTX; tmp = NEXT_INSN (tmp))
    VEC_safe_push (int, heap, *vecp, INSN_UID (tmp));
    VEC_safe_push (int, heap, *vecp, INSN_UID (tmp));
}
}
 
 
/* Set the locator of the insn chain starting at INSN to LOC.  */
/* Set the locator of the insn chain starting at INSN to LOC.  */
static void
static void
set_insn_locators (rtx insn, int loc)
set_insn_locators (rtx insn, int loc)
{
{
  while (insn != NULL_RTX)
  while (insn != NULL_RTX)
    {
    {
      if (INSN_P (insn))
      if (INSN_P (insn))
        INSN_LOCATOR (insn) = loc;
        INSN_LOCATOR (insn) = loc;
      insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
      insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
/* Determine how many INSN_UIDs in VEC are part of INSN.  Because we can
/* Determine how many INSN_UIDs in VEC are part of INSN.  Because we can
   be running after reorg, SEQUENCE rtl is possible.  */
   be running after reorg, SEQUENCE rtl is possible.  */
 
 
static int
static int
contains (rtx insn, VEC(int,heap) **vec)
contains (rtx insn, VEC(int,heap) **vec)
{
{
  int i, j;
  int i, j;
 
 
  if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)
  if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)
      && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
      && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
    {
    {
      int count = 0;
      int count = 0;
      for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
      for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
        for (j = VEC_length (int, *vec) - 1; j >= 0; --j)
        for (j = VEC_length (int, *vec) - 1; j >= 0; --j)
          if (INSN_UID (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i))
          if (INSN_UID (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i))
              == VEC_index (int, *vec, j))
              == VEC_index (int, *vec, j))
            count++;
            count++;
      return count;
      return count;
    }
    }
  else
  else
    {
    {
      for (j = VEC_length (int, *vec) - 1; j >= 0; --j)
      for (j = VEC_length (int, *vec) - 1; j >= 0; --j)
        if (INSN_UID (insn) == VEC_index (int, *vec, j))
        if (INSN_UID (insn) == VEC_index (int, *vec, j))
          return 1;
          return 1;
    }
    }
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}
 
 
int
int
prologue_epilogue_contains (rtx insn)
prologue_epilogue_contains (rtx insn)
{
{
  if (contains (insn, &prologue))
  if (contains (insn, &prologue))
    return 1;
    return 1;
  if (contains (insn, &epilogue))
  if (contains (insn, &epilogue))
    return 1;
    return 1;
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}
 
 
int
int
sibcall_epilogue_contains (rtx insn)
sibcall_epilogue_contains (rtx insn)
{
{
  if (sibcall_epilogue)
  if (sibcall_epilogue)
    return contains (insn, &sibcall_epilogue);
    return contains (insn, &sibcall_epilogue);
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}
 
 
#ifdef HAVE_return
#ifdef HAVE_return
/* Insert gen_return at the end of block BB.  This also means updating
/* Insert gen_return at the end of block BB.  This also means updating
   block_for_insn appropriately.  */
   block_for_insn appropriately.  */
 
 
static void
static void
emit_return_into_block (basic_block bb, rtx line_note)
emit_return_into_block (basic_block bb, rtx line_note)
{
{
  emit_jump_insn_after (gen_return (), BB_END (bb));
  emit_jump_insn_after (gen_return (), BB_END (bb));
  if (line_note)
  if (line_note)
    emit_note_copy_after (line_note, PREV_INSN (BB_END (bb)));
    emit_note_copy_after (line_note, PREV_INSN (BB_END (bb)));
}
}
#endif /* HAVE_return */
#endif /* HAVE_return */
 
 
#if defined(HAVE_epilogue) && defined(INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX)
#if defined(HAVE_epilogue) && defined(INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX)
 
 
/* These functions convert the epilogue into a variant that does not
/* These functions convert the epilogue into a variant that does not
   modify the stack pointer.  This is used in cases where a function
   modify the stack pointer.  This is used in cases where a function
   returns an object whose size is not known until it is computed.
   returns an object whose size is not known until it is computed.
   The called function leaves the object on the stack, leaves the
   The called function leaves the object on the stack, leaves the
   stack depressed, and returns a pointer to the object.
   stack depressed, and returns a pointer to the object.
 
 
   What we need to do is track all modifications and references to the
   What we need to do is track all modifications and references to the
   stack pointer, deleting the modifications and changing the
   stack pointer, deleting the modifications and changing the
   references to point to the location the stack pointer would have
   references to point to the location the stack pointer would have
   pointed to had the modifications taken place.
   pointed to had the modifications taken place.
 
 
   These functions need to be portable so we need to make as few
   These functions need to be portable so we need to make as few
   assumptions about the epilogue as we can.  However, the epilogue
   assumptions about the epilogue as we can.  However, the epilogue
   basically contains three things: instructions to reset the stack
   basically contains three things: instructions to reset the stack
   pointer, instructions to reload registers, possibly including the
   pointer, instructions to reload registers, possibly including the
   frame pointer, and an instruction to return to the caller.
   frame pointer, and an instruction to return to the caller.
 
 
   We must be sure of what a relevant epilogue insn is doing.  We also
   We must be sure of what a relevant epilogue insn is doing.  We also
   make no attempt to validate the insns we make since if they are
   make no attempt to validate the insns we make since if they are
   invalid, we probably can't do anything valid.  The intent is that
   invalid, we probably can't do anything valid.  The intent is that
   these routines get "smarter" as more and more machines start to use
   these routines get "smarter" as more and more machines start to use
   them and they try operating on different epilogues.
   them and they try operating on different epilogues.
 
 
   We use the following structure to track what the part of the
   We use the following structure to track what the part of the
   epilogue that we've already processed has done.  We keep two copies
   epilogue that we've already processed has done.  We keep two copies
   of the SP equivalence, one for use during the insn we are
   of the SP equivalence, one for use during the insn we are
   processing and one for use in the next insn.  The difference is
   processing and one for use in the next insn.  The difference is
   because one part of a PARALLEL may adjust SP and the other may use
   because one part of a PARALLEL may adjust SP and the other may use
   it.  */
   it.  */
 
 
struct epi_info
struct epi_info
{
{
  rtx sp_equiv_reg;             /* REG that SP is set from, perhaps SP.  */
  rtx sp_equiv_reg;             /* REG that SP is set from, perhaps SP.  */
  HOST_WIDE_INT sp_offset;      /* Offset from SP_EQUIV_REG of present SP.  */
  HOST_WIDE_INT sp_offset;      /* Offset from SP_EQUIV_REG of present SP.  */
  rtx new_sp_equiv_reg;         /* REG to be used at end of insn.  */
  rtx new_sp_equiv_reg;         /* REG to be used at end of insn.  */
  HOST_WIDE_INT new_sp_offset;  /* Offset to be used at end of insn.  */
  HOST_WIDE_INT new_sp_offset;  /* Offset to be used at end of insn.  */
  rtx equiv_reg_src;            /* If nonzero, the value that SP_EQUIV_REG
  rtx equiv_reg_src;            /* If nonzero, the value that SP_EQUIV_REG
                                   should be set to once we no longer need
                                   should be set to once we no longer need
                                   its value.  */
                                   its value.  */
  rtx const_equiv[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER]; /* Any known constant equivalences
  rtx const_equiv[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER]; /* Any known constant equivalences
                                             for registers.  */
                                             for registers.  */
};
};
 
 
static void handle_epilogue_set (rtx, struct epi_info *);
static void handle_epilogue_set (rtx, struct epi_info *);
static void update_epilogue_consts (rtx, rtx, void *);
static void update_epilogue_consts (rtx, rtx, void *);
static void emit_equiv_load (struct epi_info *);
static void emit_equiv_load (struct epi_info *);
 
 
/* Modify INSN, a list of one or more insns that is part of the epilogue, to
/* Modify INSN, a list of one or more insns that is part of the epilogue, to
   no modifications to the stack pointer.  Return the new list of insns.  */
   no modifications to the stack pointer.  Return the new list of insns.  */
 
 
static rtx
static rtx
keep_stack_depressed (rtx insns)
keep_stack_depressed (rtx insns)
{
{
  int j;
  int j;
  struct epi_info info;
  struct epi_info info;
  rtx insn, next;
  rtx insn, next;
 
 
  /* If the epilogue is just a single instruction, it must be OK as is.  */
  /* If the epilogue is just a single instruction, it must be OK as is.  */
  if (NEXT_INSN (insns) == NULL_RTX)
  if (NEXT_INSN (insns) == NULL_RTX)
    return insns;
    return insns;
 
 
  /* Otherwise, start a sequence, initialize the information we have, and
  /* Otherwise, start a sequence, initialize the information we have, and
     process all the insns we were given.  */
     process all the insns we were given.  */
  start_sequence ();
  start_sequence ();
 
 
  info.sp_equiv_reg = stack_pointer_rtx;
  info.sp_equiv_reg = stack_pointer_rtx;
  info.sp_offset = 0;
  info.sp_offset = 0;
  info.equiv_reg_src = 0;
  info.equiv_reg_src = 0;
 
 
  for (j = 0; j < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; j++)
  for (j = 0; j < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; j++)
    info.const_equiv[j] = 0;
    info.const_equiv[j] = 0;
 
 
  insn = insns;
  insn = insns;
  next = NULL_RTX;
  next = NULL_RTX;
  while (insn != NULL_RTX)
  while (insn != NULL_RTX)
    {
    {
      next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
      next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
 
 
      if (!INSN_P (insn))
      if (!INSN_P (insn))
        {
        {
          add_insn (insn);
          add_insn (insn);
          insn = next;
          insn = next;
          continue;
          continue;
        }
        }
 
 
      /* If this insn references the register that SP is equivalent to and
      /* If this insn references the register that SP is equivalent to and
         we have a pending load to that register, we must force out the load
         we have a pending load to that register, we must force out the load
         first and then indicate we no longer know what SP's equivalent is.  */
         first and then indicate we no longer know what SP's equivalent is.  */
      if (info.equiv_reg_src != 0
      if (info.equiv_reg_src != 0
          && reg_referenced_p (info.sp_equiv_reg, PATTERN (insn)))
          && reg_referenced_p (info.sp_equiv_reg, PATTERN (insn)))
        {
        {
          emit_equiv_load (&info);
          emit_equiv_load (&info);
          info.sp_equiv_reg = 0;
          info.sp_equiv_reg = 0;
        }
        }
 
 
      info.new_sp_equiv_reg = info.sp_equiv_reg;
      info.new_sp_equiv_reg = info.sp_equiv_reg;
      info.new_sp_offset = info.sp_offset;
      info.new_sp_offset = info.sp_offset;
 
 
      /* If this is a (RETURN) and the return address is on the stack,
      /* If this is a (RETURN) and the return address is on the stack,
         update the address and change to an indirect jump.  */
         update the address and change to an indirect jump.  */
      if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == RETURN
      if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == RETURN
          || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
          || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
              && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) == RETURN))
              && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) == RETURN))
        {
        {
          rtx retaddr = INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX;
          rtx retaddr = INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX;
          rtx base = 0;
          rtx base = 0;
          HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
          HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
          rtx jump_insn, jump_set;
          rtx jump_insn, jump_set;
 
 
          /* If the return address is in a register, we can emit the insn
          /* If the return address is in a register, we can emit the insn
             unchanged.  Otherwise, it must be a MEM and we see what the
             unchanged.  Otherwise, it must be a MEM and we see what the
             base register and offset are.  In any case, we have to emit any
             base register and offset are.  In any case, we have to emit any
             pending load to the equivalent reg of SP, if any.  */
             pending load to the equivalent reg of SP, if any.  */
          if (REG_P (retaddr))
          if (REG_P (retaddr))
            {
            {
              emit_equiv_load (&info);
              emit_equiv_load (&info);
              add_insn (insn);
              add_insn (insn);
              insn = next;
              insn = next;
              continue;
              continue;
            }
            }
          else
          else
            {
            {
              rtx ret_ptr;
              rtx ret_ptr;
              gcc_assert (MEM_P (retaddr));
              gcc_assert (MEM_P (retaddr));
 
 
              ret_ptr = XEXP (retaddr, 0);
              ret_ptr = XEXP (retaddr, 0);
 
 
              if (REG_P (ret_ptr))
              if (REG_P (ret_ptr))
                {
                {
                  base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, REGNO (ret_ptr));
                  base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, REGNO (ret_ptr));
                  offset = 0;
                  offset = 0;
                }
                }
              else
              else
                {
                {
                  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (ret_ptr) == PLUS
                  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (ret_ptr) == PLUS
                              && REG_P (XEXP (ret_ptr, 0))
                              && REG_P (XEXP (ret_ptr, 0))
                              && GET_CODE (XEXP (ret_ptr, 1)) == CONST_INT);
                              && GET_CODE (XEXP (ret_ptr, 1)) == CONST_INT);
                  base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, REGNO (XEXP (ret_ptr, 0)));
                  base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, REGNO (XEXP (ret_ptr, 0)));
                  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (ret_ptr, 1));
                  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (ret_ptr, 1));
                }
                }
            }
            }
 
 
          /* If the base of the location containing the return pointer
          /* If the base of the location containing the return pointer
             is SP, we must update it with the replacement address.  Otherwise,
             is SP, we must update it with the replacement address.  Otherwise,
             just build the necessary MEM.  */
             just build the necessary MEM.  */
          retaddr = plus_constant (base, offset);
          retaddr = plus_constant (base, offset);
          if (base == stack_pointer_rtx)
          if (base == stack_pointer_rtx)
            retaddr = simplify_replace_rtx (retaddr, stack_pointer_rtx,
            retaddr = simplify_replace_rtx (retaddr, stack_pointer_rtx,
                                            plus_constant (info.sp_equiv_reg,
                                            plus_constant (info.sp_equiv_reg,
                                                           info.sp_offset));
                                                           info.sp_offset));
 
 
          retaddr = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, retaddr);
          retaddr = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, retaddr);
          MEM_NOTRAP_P (retaddr) = 1;
          MEM_NOTRAP_P (retaddr) = 1;
 
 
          /* If there is a pending load to the equivalent register for SP
          /* If there is a pending load to the equivalent register for SP
             and we reference that register, we must load our address into
             and we reference that register, we must load our address into
             a scratch register and then do that load.  */
             a scratch register and then do that load.  */
          if (info.equiv_reg_src
          if (info.equiv_reg_src
              && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (info.equiv_reg_src, retaddr))
              && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (info.equiv_reg_src, retaddr))
            {
            {
              unsigned int regno;
              unsigned int regno;
              rtx reg;
              rtx reg;
 
 
              for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
              for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
                if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, Pmode)
                if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, Pmode)
                    && !fixed_regs[regno]
                    && !fixed_regs[regno]
                    && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_invalidated_by_call, regno)
                    && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_invalidated_by_call, regno)
                    && !REGNO_REG_SET_P
                    && !REGNO_REG_SET_P
                         (EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->il.rtl->global_live_at_start, regno)
                         (EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->il.rtl->global_live_at_start, regno)
                    && !refers_to_regno_p (regno,
                    && !refers_to_regno_p (regno,
                                           regno + hard_regno_nregs[regno]
                                           regno + hard_regno_nregs[regno]
                                                                   [Pmode],
                                                                   [Pmode],
                                           info.equiv_reg_src, NULL)
                                           info.equiv_reg_src, NULL)
                    && info.const_equiv[regno] == 0)
                    && info.const_equiv[regno] == 0)
                  break;
                  break;
 
 
              gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
              gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
 
 
              reg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, regno);
              reg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, regno);
              emit_move_insn (reg, retaddr);
              emit_move_insn (reg, retaddr);
              retaddr = reg;
              retaddr = reg;
            }
            }
 
 
          emit_equiv_load (&info);
          emit_equiv_load (&info);
          jump_insn = emit_jump_insn (gen_indirect_jump (retaddr));
          jump_insn = emit_jump_insn (gen_indirect_jump (retaddr));
 
 
          /* Show the SET in the above insn is a RETURN.  */
          /* Show the SET in the above insn is a RETURN.  */
          jump_set = single_set (jump_insn);
          jump_set = single_set (jump_insn);
          gcc_assert (jump_set);
          gcc_assert (jump_set);
          SET_IS_RETURN_P (jump_set) = 1;
          SET_IS_RETURN_P (jump_set) = 1;
        }
        }
 
 
      /* If SP is not mentioned in the pattern and its equivalent register, if
      /* If SP is not mentioned in the pattern and its equivalent register, if
         any, is not modified, just emit it.  Otherwise, if neither is set,
         any, is not modified, just emit it.  Otherwise, if neither is set,
         replace the reference to SP and emit the insn.  If none of those are
         replace the reference to SP and emit the insn.  If none of those are
         true, handle each SET individually.  */
         true, handle each SET individually.  */
      else if (!reg_mentioned_p (stack_pointer_rtx, PATTERN (insn))
      else if (!reg_mentioned_p (stack_pointer_rtx, PATTERN (insn))
               && (info.sp_equiv_reg == stack_pointer_rtx
               && (info.sp_equiv_reg == stack_pointer_rtx
                   || !reg_set_p (info.sp_equiv_reg, insn)))
                   || !reg_set_p (info.sp_equiv_reg, insn)))
        add_insn (insn);
        add_insn (insn);
      else if (! reg_set_p (stack_pointer_rtx, insn)
      else if (! reg_set_p (stack_pointer_rtx, insn)
               && (info.sp_equiv_reg == stack_pointer_rtx
               && (info.sp_equiv_reg == stack_pointer_rtx
                   || !reg_set_p (info.sp_equiv_reg, insn)))
                   || !reg_set_p (info.sp_equiv_reg, insn)))
        {
        {
          int changed;
          int changed;
 
 
          changed = validate_replace_rtx (stack_pointer_rtx,
          changed = validate_replace_rtx (stack_pointer_rtx,
                                          plus_constant (info.sp_equiv_reg,
                                          plus_constant (info.sp_equiv_reg,
                                                         info.sp_offset),
                                                         info.sp_offset),
                                          insn);
                                          insn);
          gcc_assert (changed);
          gcc_assert (changed);
 
 
          add_insn (insn);
          add_insn (insn);
        }
        }
      else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
      else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
        handle_epilogue_set (PATTERN (insn), &info);
        handle_epilogue_set (PATTERN (insn), &info);
      else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL)
      else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL)
        {
        {
          for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0); j++)
          for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0); j++)
            if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, j)) == SET)
            if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, j)) == SET)
              handle_epilogue_set (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, j), &info);
              handle_epilogue_set (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, j), &info);
        }
        }
      else
      else
        add_insn (insn);
        add_insn (insn);
 
 
      info.sp_equiv_reg = info.new_sp_equiv_reg;
      info.sp_equiv_reg = info.new_sp_equiv_reg;
      info.sp_offset = info.new_sp_offset;
      info.sp_offset = info.new_sp_offset;
 
 
      /* Now update any constants this insn sets.  */
      /* Now update any constants this insn sets.  */
      note_stores (PATTERN (insn), update_epilogue_consts, &info);
      note_stores (PATTERN (insn), update_epilogue_consts, &info);
      insn = next;
      insn = next;
    }
    }
 
 
  insns = get_insns ();
  insns = get_insns ();
  end_sequence ();
  end_sequence ();
  return insns;
  return insns;
}
}
 
 
/* SET is a SET from an insn in the epilogue.  P is a pointer to the epi_info
/* SET is a SET from an insn in the epilogue.  P is a pointer to the epi_info
   structure that contains information about what we've seen so far.  We
   structure that contains information about what we've seen so far.  We
   process this SET by either updating that data or by emitting one or
   process this SET by either updating that data or by emitting one or
   more insns.  */
   more insns.  */
 
 
static void
static void
handle_epilogue_set (rtx set, struct epi_info *p)
handle_epilogue_set (rtx set, struct epi_info *p)
{
{
  /* First handle the case where we are setting SP.  Record what it is being
  /* First handle the case where we are setting SP.  Record what it is being
     set from, which we must be able to determine  */
     set from, which we must be able to determine  */
  if (reg_set_p (stack_pointer_rtx, set))
  if (reg_set_p (stack_pointer_rtx, set))
    {
    {
      gcc_assert (SET_DEST (set) == stack_pointer_rtx);
      gcc_assert (SET_DEST (set) == stack_pointer_rtx);
 
 
      if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS)
      if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS)
        {
        {
          p->new_sp_equiv_reg = XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0);
          p->new_sp_equiv_reg = XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0);
          if (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) == CONST_INT)
          if (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) == CONST_INT)
            p->new_sp_offset = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1));
            p->new_sp_offset = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1));
          else
          else
            {
            {
              gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
              gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
                          && (REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
                          && (REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
                              < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                              < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
                          && p->const_equiv[REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))]);
                          && p->const_equiv[REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))]);
              p->new_sp_offset
              p->new_sp_offset
                = INTVAL (p->const_equiv[REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))]);
                = INTVAL (p->const_equiv[REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))]);
            }
            }
        }
        }
      else
      else
        p->new_sp_equiv_reg = SET_SRC (set), p->new_sp_offset = 0;
        p->new_sp_equiv_reg = SET_SRC (set), p->new_sp_offset = 0;
 
 
      /* If we are adjusting SP, we adjust from the old data.  */
      /* If we are adjusting SP, we adjust from the old data.  */
      if (p->new_sp_equiv_reg == stack_pointer_rtx)
      if (p->new_sp_equiv_reg == stack_pointer_rtx)
        {
        {
          p->new_sp_equiv_reg = p->sp_equiv_reg;
          p->new_sp_equiv_reg = p->sp_equiv_reg;
          p->new_sp_offset += p->sp_offset;
          p->new_sp_offset += p->sp_offset;
        }
        }
 
 
      gcc_assert (p->new_sp_equiv_reg && REG_P (p->new_sp_equiv_reg));
      gcc_assert (p->new_sp_equiv_reg && REG_P (p->new_sp_equiv_reg));
 
 
      return;
      return;
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Next handle the case where we are setting SP's equivalent
  /* Next handle the case where we are setting SP's equivalent
     register.  We must not already have a value to set it to.  We
     register.  We must not already have a value to set it to.  We
     could update, but there seems little point in handling that case.
     could update, but there seems little point in handling that case.
     Note that we have to allow for the case where we are setting the
     Note that we have to allow for the case where we are setting the
     register set in the previous part of a PARALLEL inside a single
     register set in the previous part of a PARALLEL inside a single
     insn.  But use the old offset for any updates within this insn.
     insn.  But use the old offset for any updates within this insn.
     We must allow for the case where the register is being set in a
     We must allow for the case where the register is being set in a
     different (usually wider) mode than Pmode).  */
     different (usually wider) mode than Pmode).  */
  else if (p->new_sp_equiv_reg != 0 && reg_set_p (p->new_sp_equiv_reg, set))
  else if (p->new_sp_equiv_reg != 0 && reg_set_p (p->new_sp_equiv_reg, set))
    {
    {
      gcc_assert (!p->equiv_reg_src
      gcc_assert (!p->equiv_reg_src
                  && REG_P (p->new_sp_equiv_reg)
                  && REG_P (p->new_sp_equiv_reg)
                  && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
                  && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
                  && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)))
                  && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)))
                      <= BITS_PER_WORD)
                      <= BITS_PER_WORD)
                  && REGNO (p->new_sp_equiv_reg) == REGNO (SET_DEST (set)));
                  && REGNO (p->new_sp_equiv_reg) == REGNO (SET_DEST (set)));
      p->equiv_reg_src
      p->equiv_reg_src
        = simplify_replace_rtx (SET_SRC (set), stack_pointer_rtx,
        = simplify_replace_rtx (SET_SRC (set), stack_pointer_rtx,
                                plus_constant (p->sp_equiv_reg,
                                plus_constant (p->sp_equiv_reg,
                                               p->sp_offset));
                                               p->sp_offset));
    }
    }
 
 
  /* Otherwise, replace any references to SP in the insn to its new value
  /* Otherwise, replace any references to SP in the insn to its new value
     and emit the insn.  */
     and emit the insn.  */
  else
  else
    {
    {
      SET_SRC (set) = simplify_replace_rtx (SET_SRC (set), stack_pointer_rtx,
      SET_SRC (set) = simplify_replace_rtx (SET_SRC (set), stack_pointer_rtx,
                                            plus_constant (p->sp_equiv_reg,
                                            plus_constant (p->sp_equiv_reg,
                                                           p->sp_offset));
                                                           p->sp_offset));
      SET_DEST (set) = simplify_replace_rtx (SET_DEST (set), stack_pointer_rtx,
      SET_DEST (set) = simplify_replace_rtx (SET_DEST (set), stack_pointer_rtx,
                                             plus_constant (p->sp_equiv_reg,
                                             plus_constant (p->sp_equiv_reg,
                                                            p->sp_offset));
                                                            p->sp_offset));
      emit_insn (set);
      emit_insn (set);
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
/* Update the tracking information for registers set to constants.  */
/* Update the tracking information for registers set to constants.  */
 
 
static void
static void
update_epilogue_consts (rtx dest, rtx x, void *data)
update_epilogue_consts (rtx dest, rtx x, void *data)
{
{
  struct epi_info *p = (struct epi_info *) data;
  struct epi_info *p = (struct epi_info *) data;
  rtx new;
  rtx new;
 
 
  if (!REG_P (dest) || REGNO (dest) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
  if (!REG_P (dest) || REGNO (dest) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
    return;
    return;
 
 
  /* If we are either clobbering a register or doing a partial set,
  /* If we are either clobbering a register or doing a partial set,
     show we don't know the value.  */
     show we don't know the value.  */
  else if (GET_CODE (x) == CLOBBER || ! rtx_equal_p (dest, SET_DEST (x)))
  else if (GET_CODE (x) == CLOBBER || ! rtx_equal_p (dest, SET_DEST (x)))
    p->const_equiv[REGNO (dest)] = 0;
    p->const_equiv[REGNO (dest)] = 0;
 
 
  /* If we are setting it to a constant, record that constant.  */
  /* If we are setting it to a constant, record that constant.  */
  else if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == CONST_INT)
  else if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == CONST_INT)
    p->const_equiv[REGNO (dest)] = SET_SRC (x);
    p->const_equiv[REGNO (dest)] = SET_SRC (x);
 
 
  /* If this is a binary operation between a register we have been tracking
  /* If this is a binary operation between a register we have been tracking
     and a constant, see if we can compute a new constant value.  */
     and a constant, see if we can compute a new constant value.  */
  else if (ARITHMETIC_P (SET_SRC (x))
  else if (ARITHMETIC_P (SET_SRC (x))
           && REG_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))
           && REG_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))
           && REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
           && REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
           && p->const_equiv[REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))] != 0
           && p->const_equiv[REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))] != 0
           && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)) == CONST_INT
           && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)) == CONST_INT
           && 0 != (new = simplify_binary_operation
           && 0 != (new = simplify_binary_operation
                    (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)), GET_MODE (dest),
                    (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)), GET_MODE (dest),
                     p->const_equiv[REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))],
                     p->const_equiv[REGNO (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))],
                     XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)))
                     XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)))
           && GET_CODE (new) == CONST_INT)
           && GET_CODE (new) == CONST_INT)
    p->const_equiv[REGNO (dest)] = new;
    p->const_equiv[REGNO (dest)] = new;
 
 
  /* Otherwise, we can't do anything with this value.  */
  /* Otherwise, we can't do anything with this value.  */
  else
  else
    p->const_equiv[REGNO (dest)] = 0;
    p->const_equiv[REGNO (dest)] = 0;
}
}
 
 
/* Emit an insn to do the load shown in p->equiv_reg_src, if needed.  */
/* Emit an insn to do the load shown in p->equiv_reg_src, if needed.  */
 
 
static void
static void
emit_equiv_load (struct epi_info *p)
emit_equiv_load (struct epi_info *p)
{
{
  if (p->equiv_reg_src != 0)
  if (p->equiv_reg_src != 0)
    {
    {
      rtx dest = p->sp_equiv_reg;
      rtx dest = p->sp_equiv_reg;
 
 
      if (GET_MODE (p->equiv_reg_src) != GET_MODE (dest))
      if (GET_MODE (p->equiv_reg_src) != GET_MODE (dest))
        dest = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (p->equiv_reg_src),
        dest = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (p->equiv_reg_src),
                            REGNO (p->sp_equiv_reg));
                            REGNO (p->sp_equiv_reg));
 
 
      emit_move_insn (dest, p->equiv_reg_src);
      emit_move_insn (dest, p->equiv_reg_src);
      p->equiv_reg_src = 0;
      p->equiv_reg_src = 0;
    }
    }
}
}
#endif
#endif
 
 
/* Generate the prologue and epilogue RTL if the machine supports it.  Thread
/* Generate the prologue and epilogue RTL if the machine supports it.  Thread
   this into place with notes indicating where the prologue ends and where
   this into place with notes indicating where the prologue ends and where
   the epilogue begins.  Update the basic block information when possible.  */
   the epilogue begins.  Update the basic block information when possible.  */
 
 
void
void
thread_prologue_and_epilogue_insns (rtx f ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
thread_prologue_and_epilogue_insns (rtx f ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
{
{
  int inserted = 0;
  int inserted = 0;
  edge e;
  edge e;
#if defined (HAVE_sibcall_epilogue) || defined (HAVE_epilogue) || defined (HAVE_return) || defined (HAVE_prologue)
#if defined (HAVE_sibcall_epilogue) || defined (HAVE_epilogue) || defined (HAVE_return) || defined (HAVE_prologue)
  rtx seq;
  rtx seq;
#endif
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_prologue
#ifdef HAVE_prologue
  rtx prologue_end = NULL_RTX;
  rtx prologue_end = NULL_RTX;
#endif
#endif
#if defined (HAVE_epilogue) || defined(HAVE_return)
#if defined (HAVE_epilogue) || defined(HAVE_return)
  rtx epilogue_end = NULL_RTX;
  rtx epilogue_end = NULL_RTX;
#endif
#endif
  edge_iterator ei;
  edge_iterator ei;
 
 
#ifdef HAVE_prologue
#ifdef HAVE_prologue
  if (HAVE_prologue)
  if (HAVE_prologue)
    {
    {
      start_sequence ();
      start_sequence ();
      seq = gen_prologue ();
      seq = gen_prologue ();
      emit_insn (seq);
      emit_insn (seq);
 
 
      /* Retain a map of the prologue insns.  */
      /* Retain a map of the prologue insns.  */
      record_insns (seq, &prologue);
      record_insns (seq, &prologue);
      prologue_end = emit_note (NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END);
      prologue_end = emit_note (NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END);
 
 
#ifndef PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
#ifndef PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
      /* Ensure that instructions are not moved into the prologue when
      /* Ensure that instructions are not moved into the prologue when
         profiling is on.  The call to the profiling routine can be
         profiling is on.  The call to the profiling routine can be
         emitted within the live range of a call-clobbered register.  */
         emitted within the live range of a call-clobbered register.  */
      if (current_function_profile)
      if (current_function_profile)
        emit_insn (gen_rtx_ASM_INPUT (VOIDmode, ""));
        emit_insn (gen_rtx_ASM_INPUT (VOIDmode, ""));
#endif
#endif
 
 
      seq = get_insns ();
      seq = get_insns ();
      end_sequence ();
      end_sequence ();
      set_insn_locators (seq, prologue_locator);
      set_insn_locators (seq, prologue_locator);
 
 
      /* Can't deal with multiple successors of the entry block
      /* Can't deal with multiple successors of the entry block
         at the moment.  Function should always have at least one
         at the moment.  Function should always have at least one
         entry point.  */
         entry point.  */
      gcc_assert (single_succ_p (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR));
      gcc_assert (single_succ_p (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR));
 
 
      insert_insn_on_edge (seq, single_succ_edge (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR));
      insert_insn_on_edge (seq, single_succ_edge (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR));
      inserted = 1;
      inserted = 1;
    }
    }
#endif
#endif
 
 
  /* If the exit block has no non-fake predecessors, we don't need
  /* If the exit block has no non-fake predecessors, we don't need
     an epilogue.  */
     an epilogue.  */
  FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->preds)
  FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->preds)
    if ((e->flags & EDGE_FAKE) == 0)
    if ((e->flags & EDGE_FAKE) == 0)
      break;
      break;
  if (e == NULL)
  if (e == NULL)
    goto epilogue_done;
    goto epilogue_done;
 
 
#ifdef HAVE_return
#ifdef HAVE_return
  if (optimize && HAVE_return)
  if (optimize && HAVE_return)
    {
    {
      /* If we're allowed to generate a simple return instruction,
      /* If we're allowed to generate a simple return instruction,
         then by definition we don't need a full epilogue.  Examine
         then by definition we don't need a full epilogue.  Examine
         the block that falls through to EXIT.   If it does not
         the block that falls through to EXIT.   If it does not
         contain any code, examine its predecessors and try to
         contain any code, examine its predecessors and try to
         emit (conditional) return instructions.  */
         emit (conditional) return instructions.  */
 
 
      basic_block last;
      basic_block last;
      rtx label;
      rtx label;
 
 
      FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->preds)
      FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->preds)
        if (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU)
        if (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU)
          break;
          break;
      if (e == NULL)
      if (e == NULL)
        goto epilogue_done;
        goto epilogue_done;
      last = e->src;
      last = e->src;
 
 
      /* Verify that there are no active instructions in the last block.  */
      /* Verify that there are no active instructions in the last block.  */
      label = BB_END (last);
      label = BB_END (last);
      while (label && !LABEL_P (label))
      while (label && !LABEL_P (label))
        {
        {
          if (active_insn_p (label))
          if (active_insn_p (label))
            break;
            break;
          label = PREV_INSN (label);
          label = PREV_INSN (label);
        }
        }
 
 
      if (BB_HEAD (last) == label && LABEL_P (label))
      if (BB_HEAD (last) == label && LABEL_P (label))
        {
        {
          edge_iterator ei2;
          edge_iterator ei2;
          rtx epilogue_line_note = NULL_RTX;
          rtx epilogue_line_note = NULL_RTX;
 
 
          /* Locate the line number associated with the closing brace,
          /* Locate the line number associated with the closing brace,
             if we can find one.  */
             if we can find one.  */
          for (seq = get_last_insn ();
          for (seq = get_last_insn ();
               seq && ! active_insn_p (seq);
               seq && ! active_insn_p (seq);
               seq = PREV_INSN (seq))
               seq = PREV_INSN (seq))
            if (NOTE_P (seq) && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (seq) > 0)
            if (NOTE_P (seq) && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (seq) > 0)
              {
              {
                epilogue_line_note = seq;
                epilogue_line_note = seq;
                break;
                break;
              }
              }
 
 
          for (ei2 = ei_start (last->preds); (e = ei_safe_edge (ei2)); )
          for (ei2 = ei_start (last->preds); (e = ei_safe_edge (ei2)); )
            {
            {
              basic_block bb = e->src;
              basic_block bb = e->src;
              rtx jump;
              rtx jump;
 
 
              if (bb == ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR)
              if (bb == ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR)
                {
                {
                  ei_next (&ei2);
                  ei_next (&ei2);
                  continue;
                  continue;
                }
                }
 
 
              jump = BB_END (bb);
              jump = BB_END (bb);
              if (!JUMP_P (jump) || JUMP_LABEL (jump) != label)
              if (!JUMP_P (jump) || JUMP_LABEL (jump) != label)
                {
                {
                  ei_next (&ei2);
                  ei_next (&ei2);
                  continue;
                  continue;
                }
                }
 
 
              /* If we have an unconditional jump, we can replace that
              /* If we have an unconditional jump, we can replace that
                 with a simple return instruction.  */
                 with a simple return instruction.  */
              if (simplejump_p (jump))
              if (simplejump_p (jump))
                {
                {
                  emit_return_into_block (bb, epilogue_line_note);
                  emit_return_into_block (bb, epilogue_line_note);
                  delete_insn (jump);
                  delete_insn (jump);
                }
                }
 
 
              /* If we have a conditional jump, we can try to replace
              /* If we have a conditional jump, we can try to replace
                 that with a conditional return instruction.  */
                 that with a conditional return instruction.  */
              else if (condjump_p (jump))
              else if (condjump_p (jump))
                {
                {
                  if (! redirect_jump (jump, 0, 0))
                  if (! redirect_jump (jump, 0, 0))
                    {
                    {
                      ei_next (&ei2);
                      ei_next (&ei2);
                      continue;
                      continue;
                    }
                    }
 
 
                  /* If this block has only one successor, it both jumps
                  /* If this block has only one successor, it both jumps
                     and falls through to the fallthru block, so we can't
                     and falls through to the fallthru block, so we can't
                     delete the edge.  */
                     delete the edge.  */
                  if (single_succ_p (bb))
                  if (single_succ_p (bb))
                    {
                    {
                      ei_next (&ei2);
                      ei_next (&ei2);
                      continue;
                      continue;
                    }
                    }
                }
                }
              else
              else
                {
                {
                  ei_next (&ei2);
                  ei_next (&ei2);
                  continue;
                  continue;
                }
                }
 
 
              /* Fix up the CFG for the successful change we just made.  */
              /* Fix up the CFG for the successful change we just made.  */
              redirect_edge_succ (e, EXIT_BLOCK_PTR);
              redirect_edge_succ (e, EXIT_BLOCK_PTR);
            }
            }
 
 
          /* Emit a return insn for the exit fallthru block.  Whether
          /* Emit a return insn for the exit fallthru block.  Whether
             this is still reachable will be determined later.  */
             this is still reachable will be determined later.  */
 
 
          emit_barrier_after (BB_END (last));
          emit_barrier_after (BB_END (last));
          emit_return_into_block (last, epilogue_line_note);
          emit_return_into_block (last, epilogue_line_note);
          epilogue_end = BB_END (last);
          epilogue_end = BB_END (last);
          single_succ_edge (last)->flags &= ~EDGE_FALLTHRU;
          single_succ_edge (last)->flags &= ~EDGE_FALLTHRU;
          goto epilogue_done;
          goto epilogue_done;
        }
        }
    }
    }
#endif
#endif
  /* Find the edge that falls through to EXIT.  Other edges may exist
  /* Find the edge that falls through to EXIT.  Other edges may exist
     due to RETURN instructions, but those don't need epilogues.
     due to RETURN instructions, but those don't need epilogues.
     There really shouldn't be a mixture -- either all should have
     There really shouldn't be a mixture -- either all should have
     been converted or none, however...  */
     been converted or none, however...  */
 
 
  FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->preds)
  FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->preds)
    if (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU)
    if (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU)
      break;
      break;
  if (e == NULL)
  if (e == NULL)
    goto epilogue_done;
    goto epilogue_done;
 
 
#ifdef HAVE_epilogue
#ifdef HAVE_epilogue
  if (HAVE_epilogue)
  if (HAVE_epilogue)
    {
    {
      start_sequence ();
      start_sequence ();
      epilogue_end = emit_note (NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG);
      epilogue_end = emit_note (NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG);
 
 
      seq = gen_epilogue ();
      seq = gen_epilogue ();
 
 
#ifdef INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
#ifdef INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
      /* If this function returns with the stack depressed and we can support
      /* If this function returns with the stack depressed and we can support
         it, massage the epilogue to actually do that.  */
         it, massage the epilogue to actually do that.  */
      if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)) == FUNCTION_TYPE
      if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)) == FUNCTION_TYPE
          && TYPE_RETURNS_STACK_DEPRESSED (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)))
          && TYPE_RETURNS_STACK_DEPRESSED (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)))
        seq = keep_stack_depressed (seq);
        seq = keep_stack_depressed (seq);
#endif
#endif
 
 
      emit_jump_insn (seq);
      emit_jump_insn (seq);
 
 
      /* Retain a map of the epilogue insns.  */
      /* Retain a map of the epilogue insns.  */
      record_insns (seq, &epilogue);
      record_insns (seq, &epilogue);
      set_insn_locators (seq, epilogue_locator);
      set_insn_locators (seq, epilogue_locator);
 
 
      seq = get_insns ();
      seq = get_insns ();
      end_sequence ();
      end_sequence ();
 
 
      insert_insn_on_edge (seq, e);
      insert_insn_on_edge (seq, e);
      inserted = 1;
      inserted = 1;
    }
    }
  else
  else
#endif
#endif
    {
    {
      basic_block cur_bb;
      basic_block cur_bb;
 
 
      if (! next_active_insn (BB_END (e->src)))
      if (! next_active_insn (BB_END (e->src)))
        goto epilogue_done;
        goto epilogue_done;
      /* We have a fall-through edge to the exit block, the source is not
      /* We have a fall-through edge to the exit block, the source is not
         at the end of the function, and there will be an assembler epilogue
         at the end of the function, and there will be an assembler epilogue
         at the end of the function.
         at the end of the function.
         We can't use force_nonfallthru here, because that would try to
         We can't use force_nonfallthru here, because that would try to
         use return.  Inserting a jump 'by hand' is extremely messy, so
         use return.  Inserting a jump 'by hand' is extremely messy, so
         we take advantage of cfg_layout_finalize using
         we take advantage of cfg_layout_finalize using
        fixup_fallthru_exit_predecessor.  */
        fixup_fallthru_exit_predecessor.  */
      cfg_layout_initialize (0);
      cfg_layout_initialize (0);
      FOR_EACH_BB (cur_bb)
      FOR_EACH_BB (cur_bb)
        if (cur_bb->index >= NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS
        if (cur_bb->index >= NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS
            && cur_bb->next_bb->index >= NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS)
            && cur_bb->next_bb->index >= NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS)
          cur_bb->aux = cur_bb->next_bb;
          cur_bb->aux = cur_bb->next_bb;
      cfg_layout_finalize ();
      cfg_layout_finalize ();
    }
    }
epilogue_done:
epilogue_done:
 
 
  if (inserted)
  if (inserted)
    commit_edge_insertions ();
    commit_edge_insertions ();
 
 
#ifdef HAVE_sibcall_epilogue
#ifdef HAVE_sibcall_epilogue
  /* Emit sibling epilogues before any sibling call sites.  */
  /* Emit sibling epilogues before any sibling call sites.  */
  for (ei = ei_start (EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->preds); (e = ei_safe_edge (ei)); )
  for (ei = ei_start (EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->preds); (e = ei_safe_edge (ei)); )
    {
    {
      basic_block bb = e->src;
      basic_block bb = e->src;
      rtx insn = BB_END (bb);
      rtx insn = BB_END (bb);
 
 
      if (!CALL_P (insn)
      if (!CALL_P (insn)
          || ! SIBLING_CALL_P (insn))
          || ! SIBLING_CALL_P (insn))
        {
        {
          ei_next (&ei);
          ei_next (&ei);
          continue;
          continue;
        }
        }
 
 
      start_sequence ();
      start_sequence ();
      emit_insn (gen_sibcall_epilogue ());
      emit_insn (gen_sibcall_epilogue ());
      seq = get_insns ();
      seq = get_insns ();
      end_sequence ();
      end_sequence ();
 
 
      /* Retain a map of the epilogue insns.  Used in life analysis to
      /* Retain a map of the epilogue insns.  Used in life analysis to
         avoid getting rid of sibcall epilogue insns.  Do this before we
         avoid getting rid of sibcall epilogue insns.  Do this before we
         actually emit the sequence.  */
         actually emit the sequence.  */
      record_insns (seq, &sibcall_epilogue);
      record_insns (seq, &sibcall_epilogue);
      set_insn_locators (seq, epilogue_locator);
      set_insn_locators (seq, epilogue_locator);
 
 
      emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
      emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
      ei_next (&ei);
      ei_next (&ei);
    }
    }
#endif
#endif
 
 
#ifdef HAVE_prologue
#ifdef HAVE_prologue
  /* This is probably all useless now that we use locators.  */
  /* This is probably all useless now that we use locators.  */
  if (prologue_end)
  if (prologue_end)
    {
    {
      rtx insn, prev;
      rtx insn, prev;
 
 
      /* GDB handles `break f' by setting a breakpoint on the first
      /* GDB handles `break f' by setting a breakpoint on the first
         line note after the prologue.  Which means (1) that if
         line note after the prologue.  Which means (1) that if
         there are line number notes before where we inserted the
         there are line number notes before where we inserted the
         prologue we should move them, and (2) we should generate a
         prologue we should move them, and (2) we should generate a
         note before the end of the first basic block, if there isn't
         note before the end of the first basic block, if there isn't
         one already there.
         one already there.
 
 
         ??? This behavior is completely broken when dealing with
         ??? This behavior is completely broken when dealing with
         multiple entry functions.  We simply place the note always
         multiple entry functions.  We simply place the note always
         into first basic block and let alternate entry points
         into first basic block and let alternate entry points
         to be missed.
         to be missed.
       */
       */
 
 
      for (insn = prologue_end; insn; insn = prev)
      for (insn = prologue_end; insn; insn = prev)
        {
        {
          prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
          prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
          if (NOTE_P (insn) && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
          if (NOTE_P (insn) && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
            {
            {
              /* Note that we cannot reorder the first insn in the
              /* Note that we cannot reorder the first insn in the
                 chain, since rest_of_compilation relies on that
                 chain, since rest_of_compilation relies on that
                 remaining constant.  */
                 remaining constant.  */
              if (prev == NULL)
              if (prev == NULL)
                break;
                break;
              reorder_insns (insn, insn, prologue_end);
              reorder_insns (insn, insn, prologue_end);
            }
            }
        }
        }
 
 
      /* Find the last line number note in the first block.  */
      /* Find the last line number note in the first block.  */
      for (insn = BB_END (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->next_bb);
      for (insn = BB_END (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->next_bb);
           insn != prologue_end && insn;
           insn != prologue_end && insn;
           insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
           insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
        if (NOTE_P (insn) && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
        if (NOTE_P (insn) && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
          break;
          break;
 
 
      /* If we didn't find one, make a copy of the first line number
      /* If we didn't find one, make a copy of the first line number
         we run across.  */
         we run across.  */
      if (! insn)
      if (! insn)
        {
        {
          for (insn = next_active_insn (prologue_end);
          for (insn = next_active_insn (prologue_end);
               insn;
               insn;
               insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
               insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
            if (NOTE_P (insn) && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
            if (NOTE_P (insn) && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
              {
              {
                emit_note_copy_after (insn, prologue_end);
                emit_note_copy_after (insn, prologue_end);
                break;
                break;
              }
              }
        }
        }
    }
    }
#endif
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_epilogue
#ifdef HAVE_epilogue
  if (epilogue_end)
  if (epilogue_end)
    {
    {
      rtx insn, next;
      rtx insn, next;
 
 
      /* Similarly, move any line notes that appear after the epilogue.
      /* Similarly, move any line notes that appear after the epilogue.
         There is no need, however, to be quite so anal about the existence
         There is no need, however, to be quite so anal about the existence
         of such a note.  Also move the NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_END and (possibly)
         of such a note.  Also move the NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_END and (possibly)
         NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG notes, as those can be relevant for debug
         NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG notes, as those can be relevant for debug
         info generation.  */
         info generation.  */
      for (insn = epilogue_end; insn; insn = next)
      for (insn = epilogue_end; insn; insn = next)
        {
        {
          next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
          next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
          if (NOTE_P (insn)
          if (NOTE_P (insn)
              && (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0
              && (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0
                  || NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG
                  || NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG
                  || NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_END))
                  || NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_END))
            reorder_insns (insn, insn, PREV_INSN (epilogue_end));
            reorder_insns (insn, insn, PREV_INSN (epilogue_end));
        }
        }
    }
    }
#endif
#endif
}
}
 
 
/* Reposition the prologue-end and epilogue-begin notes after instruction
/* Reposition the prologue-end and epilogue-begin notes after instruction
   scheduling and delayed branch scheduling.  */
   scheduling and delayed branch scheduling.  */
 
 
void
void
reposition_prologue_and_epilogue_notes (rtx f ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
reposition_prologue_and_epilogue_notes (rtx f ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
{
{
#if defined (HAVE_prologue) || defined (HAVE_epilogue)
#if defined (HAVE_prologue) || defined (HAVE_epilogue)
  rtx insn, last, note;
  rtx insn, last, note;
  int len;
  int len;
 
 
  if ((len = VEC_length (int, prologue)) > 0)
  if ((len = VEC_length (int, prologue)) > 0)
    {
    {
      last = 0, note = 0;
      last = 0, note = 0;
 
 
      /* Scan from the beginning until we reach the last prologue insn.
      /* Scan from the beginning until we reach the last prologue insn.
         We apparently can't depend on basic_block_{head,end} after
         We apparently can't depend on basic_block_{head,end} after
         reorg has run.  */
         reorg has run.  */
      for (insn = f; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
      for (insn = f; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
        {
        {
          if (NOTE_P (insn))
          if (NOTE_P (insn))
            {
            {
              if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END)
              if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END)
                note = insn;
                note = insn;
            }
            }
          else if (contains (insn, &prologue))
          else if (contains (insn, &prologue))
            {
            {
              last = insn;
              last = insn;
              if (--len == 0)
              if (--len == 0)
                break;
                break;
            }
            }
        }
        }
 
 
      if (last)
      if (last)
        {
        {
          /* Find the prologue-end note if we haven't already, and
          /* Find the prologue-end note if we haven't already, and
             move it to just after the last prologue insn.  */
             move it to just after the last prologue insn.  */
          if (note == 0)
          if (note == 0)
            {
            {
              for (note = last; (note = NEXT_INSN (note));)
              for (note = last; (note = NEXT_INSN (note));)
                if (NOTE_P (note)
                if (NOTE_P (note)
                    && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (note) == NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END)
                    && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (note) == NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END)
                  break;
                  break;
            }
            }
 
 
          /* Avoid placing note between CODE_LABEL and BASIC_BLOCK note.  */
          /* Avoid placing note between CODE_LABEL and BASIC_BLOCK note.  */
          if (LABEL_P (last))
          if (LABEL_P (last))
            last = NEXT_INSN (last);
            last = NEXT_INSN (last);
          reorder_insns (note, note, last);
          reorder_insns (note, note, last);
        }
        }
    }
    }
 
 
  if ((len = VEC_length (int, epilogue)) > 0)
  if ((len = VEC_length (int, epilogue)) > 0)
    {
    {
      last = 0, note = 0;
      last = 0, note = 0;
 
 
      /* Scan from the end until we reach the first epilogue insn.
      /* Scan from the end until we reach the first epilogue insn.
         We apparently can't depend on basic_block_{head,end} after
         We apparently can't depend on basic_block_{head,end} after
         reorg has run.  */
         reorg has run.  */
      for (insn = get_last_insn (); insn; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
      for (insn = get_last_insn (); insn; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
        {
        {
          if (NOTE_P (insn))
          if (NOTE_P (insn))
            {
            {
              if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG)
              if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG)
                note = insn;
                note = insn;
            }
            }
          else if (contains (insn, &epilogue))
          else if (contains (insn, &epilogue))
            {
            {
              last = insn;
              last = insn;
              if (--len == 0)
              if (--len == 0)
                break;
                break;
            }
            }
        }
        }
 
 
      if (last)
      if (last)
        {
        {
          /* Find the epilogue-begin note if we haven't already, and
          /* Find the epilogue-begin note if we haven't already, and
             move it to just before the first epilogue insn.  */
             move it to just before the first epilogue insn.  */
          if (note == 0)
          if (note == 0)
            {
            {
              for (note = insn; (note = PREV_INSN (note));)
              for (note = insn; (note = PREV_INSN (note));)
                if (NOTE_P (note)
                if (NOTE_P (note)
                    && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (note) == NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG)
                    && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (note) == NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG)
                  break;
                  break;
            }
            }
 
 
          if (PREV_INSN (last) != note)
          if (PREV_INSN (last) != note)
            reorder_insns (note, note, PREV_INSN (last));
            reorder_insns (note, note, PREV_INSN (last));
        }
        }
    }
    }
#endif /* HAVE_prologue or HAVE_epilogue */
#endif /* HAVE_prologue or HAVE_epilogue */
}
}
 
 
/* Resets insn_block_boundaries array.  */
/* Resets insn_block_boundaries array.  */
 
 
void
void
reset_block_changes (void)
reset_block_changes (void)
{
{
  cfun->ib_boundaries_block = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 100);
  cfun->ib_boundaries_block = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 100);
  VEC_quick_push (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block, NULL_TREE);
  VEC_quick_push (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block, NULL_TREE);
}
}
 
 
/* Record the boundary for BLOCK.  */
/* Record the boundary for BLOCK.  */
void
void
record_block_change (tree block)
record_block_change (tree block)
{
{
  int i, n;
  int i, n;
  tree last_block;
  tree last_block;
 
 
  if (!block)
  if (!block)
    return;
    return;
 
 
  if(!cfun->ib_boundaries_block)
  if(!cfun->ib_boundaries_block)
    return;
    return;
 
 
  last_block = VEC_pop (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block);
  last_block = VEC_pop (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block);
  n = get_max_uid ();
  n = get_max_uid ();
  for (i = VEC_length (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block); i < n; i++)
  for (i = VEC_length (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block); i < n; i++)
    VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, cfun->ib_boundaries_block, last_block);
    VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, cfun->ib_boundaries_block, last_block);
 
 
  VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, cfun->ib_boundaries_block, block);
  VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, cfun->ib_boundaries_block, block);
}
}
 
 
/* Finishes record of boundaries.  */
/* Finishes record of boundaries.  */
void
void
finalize_block_changes (void)
finalize_block_changes (void)
{
{
  record_block_change (DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl));
  record_block_change (DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl));
}
}
 
 
/* For INSN return the BLOCK it belongs to.  */
/* For INSN return the BLOCK it belongs to.  */
void
void
check_block_change (rtx insn, tree *block)
check_block_change (rtx insn, tree *block)
{
{
  unsigned uid = INSN_UID (insn);
  unsigned uid = INSN_UID (insn);
 
 
  if (uid >= VEC_length (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block))
  if (uid >= VEC_length (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block))
    return;
    return;
 
 
  *block = VEC_index (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block, uid);
  *block = VEC_index (tree, cfun->ib_boundaries_block, uid);
}
}
 
 
/* Releases the ib_boundaries_block records.  */
/* Releases the ib_boundaries_block records.  */
void
void
free_block_changes (void)
free_block_changes (void)
{
{
  VEC_free (tree, gc, cfun->ib_boundaries_block);
  VEC_free (tree, gc, cfun->ib_boundaries_block);
}
}
 
 
/* Returns the name of the current function.  */
/* Returns the name of the current function.  */
const char *
const char *
current_function_name (void)
current_function_name (void)
{
{
  return lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (cfun->decl, 2);
  return lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (cfun->decl, 2);
}
}


 
 
static unsigned int
static unsigned int
rest_of_handle_check_leaf_regs (void)
rest_of_handle_check_leaf_regs (void)
{
{
#ifdef LEAF_REGISTERS
#ifdef LEAF_REGISTERS
  current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
  current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
    = optimize > 0 && only_leaf_regs_used () && leaf_function_p ();
    = optimize > 0 && only_leaf_regs_used () && leaf_function_p ();
#endif
#endif
  return 0;
  return 0;
}
}
 
 
/* Insert a TYPE into the used types hash table of CFUN.  */
/* Insert a TYPE into the used types hash table of CFUN.  */
static void
static void
used_types_insert_helper (tree type, struct function *func)
used_types_insert_helper (tree type, struct function *func)
{
{
  if (type != NULL && func != NULL)
  if (type != NULL && func != NULL)
    {
    {
      void **slot;
      void **slot;
 
 
      if (func->used_types_hash == NULL)
      if (func->used_types_hash == NULL)
        func->used_types_hash = htab_create_ggc (37, htab_hash_pointer,
        func->used_types_hash = htab_create_ggc (37, htab_hash_pointer,
                                                 htab_eq_pointer, NULL);
                                                 htab_eq_pointer, NULL);
      slot = htab_find_slot (func->used_types_hash, type, INSERT);
      slot = htab_find_slot (func->used_types_hash, type, INSERT);
      if (*slot == NULL)
      if (*slot == NULL)
        *slot = type;
        *slot = type;
    }
    }
}
}
 
 
/* Given a type, insert it into the used hash table in cfun.  */
/* Given a type, insert it into the used hash table in cfun.  */
void
void
used_types_insert (tree t)
used_types_insert (tree t)
{
{
  while (POINTER_TYPE_P (t) || TREE_CODE (t) == ARRAY_TYPE)
  while (POINTER_TYPE_P (t) || TREE_CODE (t) == ARRAY_TYPE)
    t = TREE_TYPE (t);
    t = TREE_TYPE (t);
  t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (t);
  t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (t);
  if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE)
  if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE)
    used_types_insert_helper (t, cfun);
    used_types_insert_helper (t, cfun);
}
}
 
 
struct tree_opt_pass pass_leaf_regs =
struct tree_opt_pass pass_leaf_regs =
{
{
  NULL,                                 /* name */
  NULL,                                 /* name */
  NULL,                                 /* gate */
  NULL,                                 /* gate */
  rest_of_handle_check_leaf_regs,       /* execute */
  rest_of_handle_check_leaf_regs,       /* execute */
  NULL,                                 /* sub */
  NULL,                                 /* sub */
  NULL,                                 /* next */
  NULL,                                 /* next */
  0,                                    /* static_pass_number */
  0,                                    /* static_pass_number */
  0,                                    /* tv_id */
  0,                                    /* tv_id */
  0,                                    /* properties_required */
  0,                                    /* properties_required */
  0,                                    /* properties_provided */
  0,                                    /* properties_provided */
  0,                                    /* properties_destroyed */
  0,                                    /* properties_destroyed */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_start */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_start */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_finish */
  0,                                    /* todo_flags_finish */
  0                                     /* letter */
  0                                     /* letter */
};
};
 
 
 
 
#include "gt-function.h"
#include "gt-function.h"
 
 

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.